blob: ca48cab6d1c8b8ee9fb3e3135d16d77ada150835 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau0b787922017-11-26 19:25:23 +01007 2017/11/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011110. Cache
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112
1131. Quick reminder about HTTP
114----------------------------
115
116When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
117fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
118on almost anything found in the contents.
119
120However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
121formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
122correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
123
124
1251.1. The HTTP transaction model
126-------------------------------
127
128The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100129to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
131connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
132will involve a new connection :
133
134 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
135
136In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
137establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
138by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
139length.
140
141Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
142to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
143however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
144response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
145header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
146
147 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
148
149Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
150power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
151but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200152a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100154Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
156second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
157page :
158
159 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
160
161This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
162latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
163correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
164the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100165server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100167The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
168time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
169are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
170parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
171carry the stream identifier.
172
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100173By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
174connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
175leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100176start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
177processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
178waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200179
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100180HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
181 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
182 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
183 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
184 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
185 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
186 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
187
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100188For HTTP/2, the connection mode ressembles more the "server close" mode : given
189the independance of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
190server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
191is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
192servers.
193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194
1951.2. HTTP request
196-----------------
197
198First, let's consider this HTTP request :
199
200 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100201 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
203 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
204 3 User-agent: my small browser
205 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
206 5 Accept: image/png
207
208
2091.2.1. The Request line
210-----------------------
211
212Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
213
214 - a METHOD : GET
215 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
216 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
217
218All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
219which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
220followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
221is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
222desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
223the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
224
225The URI itself can have several forms :
226
227 - A "relative URI" :
228
229 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
230
231 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
232 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
233
234 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
235
236 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
237
238 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
239 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
240 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
241 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
242 must accept this form too.
243
244 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
245 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
246 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100247
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200248 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
249 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
250 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
251 other protocols too.
252
253In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
254mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
255on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
256It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
257specific to the language, framework or application in use.
258
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100259HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
260assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (ie: "HTTP/2").
261However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
262received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
263processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
264as well as in server logs.
265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266
2671.2.2. The request headers
268--------------------------
269
270The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
271beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
272an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
273Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
274values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
275encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
276the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
277define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
278
279Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
280their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100281"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
282as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200283
284The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
285that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
286is one valid form of empty line.
287
288Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
289headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
290about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
291application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
292
293Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000294 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
296 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
297 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
298
299
3001.3. HTTP response
301------------------
302
303An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
304messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
305
306 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
309 2 Content-length: 350
310 3 Content-Type: text/html
311
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200312As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
313codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
314response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100315continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
316the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
317following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
318sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
319(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
320correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
321such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
322state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
323over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
324if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
325information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200327
3281.3.1. The Response line
329------------------------
330
331Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
332
333 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
334 - a status code : 200
335 - a reason : OK
336
337The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200338 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
340 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
341 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
342 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
343
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000344Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100345"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
347messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
348or "Authentication Required".
349
350Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
351
352 Code When / reason
353 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
354 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
355 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
356 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100357 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
358 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359 400 for an invalid or too large request
360 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
361 accessing the stats page)
362 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
363 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
364 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
365 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
366 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
367 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
368 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
369 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
370 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
371
372The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3734.2).
374
375
3761.3.2. The response headers
377---------------------------
378
379Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
380the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
381details.
382
383
3842. Configuring HAProxy
385----------------------
386
3872.1. Configuration file format
388------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200389
390HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
391
392 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
393 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
394 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
395 "frontend" and "backend".
396
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100397The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
398referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200399delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200401
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004022.2. Quoting and escaping
403-------------------------
404
405HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
406many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
407with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
408single quotes.
409
410If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
411them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
412escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
413
414Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
415
416 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
417 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
418 \\ to use a backslash
419 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
420 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
421
422Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
423the interpretation of:
424
425 space as a parameter separator
426 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
427 # hash as a comment start
428
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200429Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
430-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
431backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
432
433Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200434quoting.
435
436Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
437nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
438
439Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
440equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
441
442 Example:
443 # those are equivalents:
444 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
445 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
446 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
447 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
448 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
449
450 # those are equivalents:
451 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
452 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
453 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
454 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
455
456
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004572.3. Environment variables
458--------------------------
459
460HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
461interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
462configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
463optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
464shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
465underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
466
467 Example:
468
469 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
470
471 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
472
473 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
474
475
4762.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200477----------------
478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100479Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100480values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
481otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
482numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
483for every keyword. Supported units are :
484
485 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
486 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
487 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
488 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
489 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
490 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
491
492
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004932.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200494-------------
495
496 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
497 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
498 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
499 global
500 daemon
501 maxconn 256
502
503 defaults
504 mode http
505 timeout connect 5000ms
506 timeout client 50000ms
507 timeout server 50000ms
508
509 frontend http-in
510 bind *:80
511 default_backend servers
512
513 backend servers
514 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
515
516
517 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
518 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
519 global
520 daemon
521 maxconn 256
522
523 defaults
524 mode http
525 timeout connect 5000ms
526 timeout client 50000ms
527 timeout server 50000ms
528
529 listen http-in
530 bind *:80
531 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
532
533
534Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
535
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100536 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200537
538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005393. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540--------------------
541
542Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
543are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
544of them have command-line equivalents.
545
546The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
547
548 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200549 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200551 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200553 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200554 - description
555 - deviceatlas-json-file
556 - deviceatlas-log-level
557 - deviceatlas-separator
558 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900559 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - gid
561 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100562 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200563 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200564 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100565 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200566 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200568 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200569 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100571 - presetenv
572 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 - uid
574 - ulimit-n
575 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100576 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200577 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
579 - ssl-default-bind-options
580 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
581 - ssl-default-server-options
582 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100583 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100584 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100585 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100586 - 51degrees-data-file
587 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200588 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200589 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100590 - wurfl-data-file
591 - wurfl-information-list
592 - wurfl-information-list-separator
593 - wurfl-engine-mode
594 - wurfl-cache-size
595 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100596
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200598 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200600 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100601 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100602 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100603 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200604 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200605 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200606 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - noepoll
609 - nokqueue
610 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100611 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300612 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000613 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200614 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200615 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200616 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000617 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000618 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200619 - tune.buffers.limit
620 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200621 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200622 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100623 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200624 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200625 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200626 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100627 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200628 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200629 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100630 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100631 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100632 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100633 - tune.lua.session-timeout
634 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200635 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100636 - tune.maxaccept
637 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200638 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200639 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200640 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100641 - tune.rcvbuf.client
642 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100643 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100644 - tune.sndbuf.client
645 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100646 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100647 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200648 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100649 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200650 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200651 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100652 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200653 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100654 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200655 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
656 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
657 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100658 - tune.zlib.memlevel
659 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100660
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661 * Debugging
662 - debug
663 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200664
665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006663.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200667------------------------------------
668
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200669ca-base <dir>
670 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200671 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
672 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674chroot <jail dir>
675 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
676 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
677 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
678 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
679 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
680 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100681
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100682cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
683 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
684 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
685 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
686 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
687 set. These sets have the format
688
689 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
690
691 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
692 word size. any process IDs above nbrpoc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
693 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
694 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100695 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
696 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
697 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
698 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100699 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
700 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
701 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
702 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
703 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
704 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100705
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100706 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
707 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
708 on the machine's word size.
709
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100710 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
712 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
713 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
714 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
715 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
716 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100717
718 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100719 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
720
721 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
722 # first 4 CPUs
723
724 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
725 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
726 # word size.
727
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100729 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100730 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
731 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
732 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
733
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100734 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
735 # and so on.
736 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
737 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
738 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
739
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100740 # bind each process to exaclty one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
741 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
742 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
743 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
744
745 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
746 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
747 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
748
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
750 # and a thread range.
751 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
752 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
753 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
754
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200755crt-base <dir>
756 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
757 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
758 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
759
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200760daemon
761 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
762 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100763 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
764 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200765
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200766deviceatlas-json-file <path>
767 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
768 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
769
770deviceatlas-log-level <value>
771 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
772 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
773
774deviceatlas-separator <char>
775 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
776 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
777
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100778deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200779 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
780 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
781 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100782
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900783external-check
784 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
785 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
786 See "option external-check".
787
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200788gid <number>
789 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
790 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
791 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100792 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
793 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200794 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100795
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100796hard-stop-after <time>
797 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
798
799 Arguments :
800 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
801 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
802 SIGUSR1 signal.
803
804 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
805 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
806 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
807
808 Example:
809 global
810 hard-stop-after 30s
811
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200812group <group name>
813 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
814 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100815
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200816log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
818 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100819 configured with "log global".
820
821 <address> can be one of:
822
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100823 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100824 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
825 port).
826
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100827 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
828 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
829 port).
830
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100831 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
832 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
833 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
834 writeable).
835
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200836 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
837 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100838
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200839 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
840 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
841 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
842 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
843 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
844 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
845 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
846 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
847 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
848 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200849 JSON-formated logs may require larger values. You may also need to
850 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request uris are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200851
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200852 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
853 one of the following :
854
855 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
856 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
857
858 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
859 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
860
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100861 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200862
863 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
864 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
865 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
866
867 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200868 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
869 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
870 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
871 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
872 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
873 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200874
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200875 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200876
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100877log-send-hostname [<string>]
878 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
879 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
880 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
881 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
882 the logs.
883
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000884log-tag <string>
885 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
886 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
887 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100888 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000889
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100890lua-load <file>
891 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
892 used multiple times.
893
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100894master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200895 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
896 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
897 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
898 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
899 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
900 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100901 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
902 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
903 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
904 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
905 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200906
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100907 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200908
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200909nbproc <number>
910 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
911 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
912 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
913 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
914 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
915
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200916nbthread <number>
917 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
918 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
919 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
920 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
921 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
922
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923pidfile <pidfile>
924 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
925 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
926 starting the process. See also "daemon".
927
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100928presetenv <name> <value>
929 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
930 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
931 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
932 and "unsetenv".
933
934resetenv [<name> ...]
935 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
936 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
937 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
938 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
939 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
940 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
941 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
942 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
943
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100944stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200945 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
946 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
947 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
948 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
949 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
950 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100951 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100952 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
953 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
954 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
955 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200956
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200957server-state-base <directory>
958 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200959 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
960 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200961
962server-state-file <file>
963 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
964 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
965 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
966 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
967 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
968 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
969 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
970 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200971 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
972 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200973
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100974setenv <name> <value>
975 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
976 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
977 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
978 and "unsetenv".
979
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100980ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
981 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
982 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300983 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100984 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
985 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
986 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
987 "bind" keyword for more information.
988
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100989ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
990 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
991 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
992 keyword to see available options.
993
994 Example:
995 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200996 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100997
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100998ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
999 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1000 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001001 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001002 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
1003 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
1004 information.
1005
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001006ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1007 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1008 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1009 keyword to see available options.
1010
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001011ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1012 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1013 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1014 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
1015 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
1016 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001017 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1018 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1019 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1020 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001021 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1022 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1023 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1024
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001025ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1026 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1027 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1028 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1029
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001030stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1031 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1032 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1033 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001034 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001035 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001036
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001037 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1038 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1039 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001040
1041stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1042 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1043 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001044 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001045
1046stats maxconn <connections>
1047 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1048 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1049
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001050uid <number>
1051 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1052 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1053 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1054 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1055
1056ulimit-n <number>
1057 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1058 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1059 option.
1060
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001061unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1062 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1063
1064 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1065 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1066 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1067 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1068 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1069 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1070 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1071 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1072 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1073 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1074
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001075unsetenv [<name> ...]
1076 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1077 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1078 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1079 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1080 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1081 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1082 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1083
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001084user <user name>
1085 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1086 See also "uid" and "group".
1087
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001088node <name>
1089 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1090
1091 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1092 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1093 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1094 traffic.
1095
1096description <text>
1097 Add a text that describes the instance.
1098
1099 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1100 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1101 "<" and ">" characters.
1102
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100110351degrees-data-file <file path>
1104 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1105 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1106
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001107 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001108 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1109
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000111051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001111 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1112 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1113 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1114
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001115 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001116 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1117
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200111851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001119 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1120 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1121
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001122 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1123 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1124
112551degrees-cache-size <number>
1126 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1127 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1128 By default, this cache is disabled.
1129
1130 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001131 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1132
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001133wurfl-data-file <file path>
1134 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1135 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1136
1137 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1138 with USE_WURFL=1.
1139
1140wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1141 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1142 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1143 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1144
1145 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1146
1147 Valid WURFL properties are:
1148 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1149
1150 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1151 device.
1152
1153 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1154 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1155
1156 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1157 particular web request.
1158
1159 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1160 used Libwurfl API version.
1161
1162 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1163 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1164 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1165
1166 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1167 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1168
1169 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1170 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1171
1172 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1173
1174 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1175
1176 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1177 with USE_WURFL=1.
1178
1179wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1180 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1181 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1182
1183 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1184 with USE_WURFL=1.
1185
1186wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1187 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1188 thus before the chroot.
1189
1190 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1191 with USE_WURFL=1.
1192
1193wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1194 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1195 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1196 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1197 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1198 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1199 mode is enabled by default.
1200
1201 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1202 with USE_WURFL=1.
1203
1204wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1205 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1206 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1207 - "0" : no cache is used.
1208 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1209 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1210 the highest performing option.
1211
1212 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1213 with USE_WURFL=1.
1214
1215wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1216 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1217 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1218
1219 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1220 with USE_WURFL=1.
1221
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012233.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001224-----------------------
1225
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001226max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1227 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1228 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1229 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1230 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1231 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1232 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1233 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1234 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1235
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001236maxconn <number>
1237 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1238 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1239 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001240 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1241 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1242 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1243 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001244 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1245 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1246 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1247 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1248 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001249
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001250maxconnrate <number>
1251 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1252 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1253 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1254 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1255 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1256 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1257 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1258 fairness.
1259
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001260maxcomprate <number>
1261 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001262 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001263 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1264 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1265 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1266 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1267 default value.
1268
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001269maxcompcpuusage <number>
1270 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1271 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1272 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1273 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1274 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1275 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1276 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1277 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1278
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001279maxpipes <number>
1280 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1281 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1282 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1283 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1284 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1285 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1286
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001287maxsessrate <number>
1288 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1289 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1290 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1291 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1292 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1293 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1294 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1295 fairness.
1296
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001297maxsslconn <number>
1298 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1299 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1300 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1301 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1302 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1303 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1304 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001305 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1306 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1307 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1308 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1309 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1310 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1311 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001312
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001313maxsslrate <number>
1314 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1315 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1316 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1317 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1318 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1319 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1320 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1321 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1322 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1323 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1324
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001325maxzlibmem <number>
1326 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1327 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1328 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001329 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1330 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1331 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1332
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001333noepoll
1334 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1335 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001336 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001337
1338nokqueue
1339 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1340 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1341 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1342
1343nopoll
1344 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1345 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001346 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001347 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001348
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001349nosplice
1350 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1351 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1352 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001353 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001354 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1355 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1356 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1357 "option splice-response".
1358
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001359nogetaddrinfo
1360 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1361 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1362
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001363noreuseport
1364 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1365 command line argument "-dR".
1366
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001367spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001368 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1369 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1370 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1371 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1372 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1373 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001374
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001375ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1376 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1377 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1378 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1379 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1380 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1381 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1382 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1383 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1384 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1385 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1386 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1387 openssl configuration file uses:
1388 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1389
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001390ssl-mode-async
1391 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001392 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001393 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1394 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1395 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1396 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1397 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001398
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001399tune.buffers.limit <number>
1400 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1401 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1402 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1403 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1404 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1405 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1406 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1407 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1408 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1409 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1410 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1411 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1412 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1413 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1414 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1415
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001416tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1417 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1418 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1419 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1420 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1421
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001422tune.bufsize <number>
1423 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1424 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1425 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1426 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1427 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1428 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1429 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001430 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1431 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1432 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001433 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1434 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001435
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001436tune.chksize <number>
1437 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1438 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1439 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1440 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1441 checks whenever possible.
1442
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001443tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1444 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1445 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1446 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1447 this value. The default value is 1.
1448
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001449tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1450 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1451 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1452 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1453 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1454 change it.
1455
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001456tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1457 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
1458 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgement from haproxy. This setting
1459 only affects payload contents (ie: the body of POST requests), not headers.
1460 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1461 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1462 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1463 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1464 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1465
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001466tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1467 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1468 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1469 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1470 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1471 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1472 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1473 recommended not to change this value.
1474
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001475tune.http.cookielen <number>
1476 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1477 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1478 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1479 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1480 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1481 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1482 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1483 to change this value.
1484
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001485tune.http.logurilen <number>
1486 Sets the maximum length of request uri in logs. This prevent to truncate long
1487 requests uris with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
1488 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
1489 'log ... len yyyy' parameter. Your syslog deamon may also need specific
1490 configuration directives too.
1491 The default value is 1024.
1492
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001493tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1494 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1495 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1496 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1497 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1498 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1499 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001500 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1501 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1502 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001503
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001504tune.idletimer <timeout>
1505 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1506 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1507 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1508 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1509 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1510 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1511 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1512 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1513 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1514
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001515tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1516 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001517 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001518 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1519 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1520 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1521 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1522 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1523
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001524tune.lua.maxmem
1525 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1526 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1527 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1528 memory.
1529
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001530tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1531 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001532 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1533 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1534 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001535
1536tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1537 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1538 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1539 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1540 check servers.
1541
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001542tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1543 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1544 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1545 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1546 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1547
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001548tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001549 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1550 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1551 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1552 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1553 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1554 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1555 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1556 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1557 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1558 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001559
1560tune.maxpollevents <number>
1561 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1562 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1563 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1564 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1565 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1566
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001567tune.maxrewrite <number>
1568 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1569 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1570 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1571 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1572 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1573 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1574 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1575 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1576 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1577 bufsize.
1578
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001579tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1580 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1581 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1582 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1583 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1584 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1585 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1586 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1587 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1588 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1589 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1590 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1591 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1592 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1593 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1594 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1595 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1596 setting this parameter to 0.
1597
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001598tune.pipesize <number>
1599 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1600 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1601 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1602 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1603 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1604 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1605
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001606tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1607tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1608 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1609 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1610 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1611 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1612 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1613 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1614 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1615
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001616tune.recv_enough <number>
1617 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1618 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1619 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1620 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1621 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1622
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001623tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1624tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1625 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1626 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1627 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1628 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1629 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1630 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1631 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1632 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1633 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1634 notifying haproxy again.
1635
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001636tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001637 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1638 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1639 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001640 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001641 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1642 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1643 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1644 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1645 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001646 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1647 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001648
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001649tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1650 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1651 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1652 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1653 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1654 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1655 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1656
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001657tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1658 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001659 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001660 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1661 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1662 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1663 being used for too long.
1664
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001665tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1666 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1667 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1668 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1669 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1670 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1671 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1672 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1673 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1674 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1675 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001676 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1677 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001678
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001679tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1680 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1681 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1682 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1683 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1684 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1685 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1686 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001687 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1688 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001689
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001690tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1691 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1692 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1693 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1694 1000 entries.
1695
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001696tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1697 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1698 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1699 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1700
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001701tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001702tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001703tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1704tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1705tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001706 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1707 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1708 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1709 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1710 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1711 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1712 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1713 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001714
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001715 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1716 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1717 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1718 all available space is consumed.
1719 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1720 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1721 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001722
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001723tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1724 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001725 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001726 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1727 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1728 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1729
1730tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1731 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1732 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1733 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1734 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017363.3. Debugging
1737--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001738
1739debug
1740 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1741 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1742 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1743 system startup.
1744
1745quiet
1746 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1747 line argument "-q".
1748
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001749
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017503.4. Userlists
1751--------------
1752It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1753http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1754it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1755
1756userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001757 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001758 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1759
1760group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001761 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001762 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1763 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1764
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001765user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1766 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001767 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1768 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001769 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1770 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1771 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1772 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001773
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001774 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1775 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1776 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1777 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1778 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1779 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1780 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1781 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1782 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001783
1784 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001785 userlist L1
1786 group G1 users tiger,scott
1787 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001788
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001789 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1790 user scott insecure-password elgato
1791 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001792
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001793 userlist L2
1794 group G1
1795 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001796
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001797 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1798 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1799 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001800
1801 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001802
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001803
18043.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001805----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001806It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1807several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1808instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1809values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1810automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1811In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1812using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1813tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1814reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1815Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1816that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1817each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001818
1819peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001820 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001821 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1822
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001823disabled
1824 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1825 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1826 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1827
1828enable
1829 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1830
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001831peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1832 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1833 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1834 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1835 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1836 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1837 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1838
1839 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1840 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1841
1842 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1843 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1844 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1845 across all peers.
1846
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001847 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1848 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001849
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001850 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001851 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001852 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1853 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1854 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001855
1856 backend mybackend
1857 mode tcp
1858 balance roundrobin
1859 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1860 stick on src
1861
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001862 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1863 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001864
1865
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090018663.6. Mailers
1867------------
1868It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1869If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1870in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1871
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001872mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001873 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1874 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1875
1876mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1877 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1878
1879 Example:
1880 mailers mymailers
1881 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1882 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1883
1884 backend mybackend
1885 mode tcp
1886 balance roundrobin
1887
1888 email-alert mailers mymailers
1889 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1890 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1891
1892 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1893 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1894
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001895timeout mail <time>
1896 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1897 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1898 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1899 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1900
1901 Example:
1902 mailers mymailers
1903 timeout mail 20s
1904 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019064. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001907----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001908
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001909Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001910 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001911 - frontend <name>
1912 - backend <name>
1913 - listen <name>
1914
1915A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1916its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1917section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001919
1920A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1921connections.
1922
1923A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1924to forward incoming connections.
1925
1926A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1927parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1928
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001929All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1930'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1931case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1932
1933Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1934logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1935proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1936However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1937name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1938
1939Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1940and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001941bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001942protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1943modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1944arbitrary criteria.
1945
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001946In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1947a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1948the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1949
1950 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1951 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1952 between responses and new requests.
1953
1954 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1955 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1956 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1957 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1958
1959 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1960 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1961 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1962
1963 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1964 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1965 client-facing connection remains open.
1966
1967 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1968 after the end of the response.
1969
1970The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1971frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1972following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1973weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1974
1975 Backend mode
1976
1977 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1978 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1979 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1980 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1981 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1982 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1983 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1984 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1985 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1986 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1987 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1988
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001989
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019914.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1992--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001994The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1995limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1996they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1997limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001998marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001999option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002000and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2001with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2002specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002003
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002004
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002005 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2006------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2007acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002008appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002009backlog X X X -
2010balance X - X X
2011bind - X X -
2012bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002013block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002014capture cookie - X X -
2015capture request header - X X -
2016capture response header - X X -
2017clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002018compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002019contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2020cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002021declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002022default-server X - X X
2023default_backend X X X -
2024description - X X X
2025disabled X X X X
2026dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002027email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002028email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002029email-alert mailers X X X X
2030email-alert myhostname X X X X
2031email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002032enabled X X X X
2033errorfile X X X X
2034errorloc X X X X
2035errorloc302 X X X X
2036-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2037errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002038force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002039filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002040fullconn X - X X
2041grace X X X X
2042hash-type X - X X
2043http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002044http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002045http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002046http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002047http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002048http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002049http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002050id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002051ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002052load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002053log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002054log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002055log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002056log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002057max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002058maxconn X X X -
2059mode X X X X
2060monitor fail - X X -
2061monitor-net X X X -
2062monitor-uri X X X -
2063option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2064option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2065option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2066option allbackups (*) X - X X
2067option checkcache (*) X - X X
2068option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2069option contstats (*) X X X -
2070option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2071option dontlognull (*) X X X -
2072option forceclose (*) X X X X
2073-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2074option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002075option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002076option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002077option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002078option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002079option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002080option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01002081option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002082option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2083option httpchk X - X X
2084option httpclose (*) X X X X
2085option httplog X X X X
2086option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002087option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002088option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002089option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002090option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2091option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2092option logasap (*) X X X -
2093option mysql-check X - X X
2094option nolinger (*) X X X X
2095option originalto X X X X
2096option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002097option pgsql-check X - X X
2098option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002099option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002100option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002101option smtpchk X - X X
2102option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2103option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2104option splice-request (*) X X X X
2105option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002106option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002107option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2108option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2109-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002110option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002111option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2112option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2113option tcpka X X X X
2114option tcplog X X X X
2115option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002116external-check command X - X X
2117external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002118persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2119rate-limit sessions X X X -
2120redirect - X X X
2121redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2122redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2123reqadd - X X X
2124reqallow - X X X
2125reqdel - X X X
2126reqdeny - X X X
2127reqiallow - X X X
2128reqidel - X X X
2129reqideny - X X X
2130reqipass - X X X
2131reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002132reqitarpit - X X X
2133reqpass - X X X
2134reqrep - X X X
2135-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002136reqtarpit - X X X
2137retries X - X X
2138rspadd - X X X
2139rspdel - X X X
2140rspdeny - X X X
2141rspidel - X X X
2142rspideny - X X X
2143rspirep - X X X
2144rsprep - X X X
2145server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002146server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002147server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002148source X - X X
2149srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002150stats admin - X X X
2151stats auth X X X X
2152stats enable X X X X
2153stats hide-version X X X X
2154stats http-request - X X X
2155stats realm X X X X
2156stats refresh X X X X
2157stats scope X X X X
2158stats show-desc X X X X
2159stats show-legends X X X X
2160stats show-node X X X X
2161stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002162-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2163stick match - - X X
2164stick on - - X X
2165stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002166stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002167stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002168tcp-check connect - - X X
2169tcp-check expect - - X X
2170tcp-check send - - X X
2171tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002172tcp-request connection - X X -
2173tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002174tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002175tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002176tcp-response content - - X X
2177tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002178timeout check X - X X
2179timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002180timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002181timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2182timeout connect X - X X
2183timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2184timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2185timeout http-request X X X X
2186timeout queue X - X X
2187timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002188timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002189timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2190timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002191timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002192transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002193unique-id-format X X X -
2194unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002195use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002196use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002197------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2198 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002199
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022014.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2202---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002203
2204This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2205
2206
2207acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2208 Declare or complete an access list.
2209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2210 no | yes | yes | yes
2211 Example:
2212 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2213 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2214 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002216 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002217
2218
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002219appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2220 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002221 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2223 no | no | yes | yes
2224 Arguments :
2225 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2226 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2227
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002228 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002229 checked in each cookie value.
2230
2231 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2232 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2233 milliseconds.
2234
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002235 request-learn
2236 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2237 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2238 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2239 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2240 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2241 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2242
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002243 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2244 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2245 data following this prefix.
2246
2247 Example :
2248 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2249
2250 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2251 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2252
2253 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2254 2 modes are currently supported :
2255 - path-parameters :
2256 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2257 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2258 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2259 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2260 - query-string :
2261 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2262 query string.
2263
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002264 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2265 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2266 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002267
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002268 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2269 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002270
2271
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002272backlog <conns>
2273 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2275 yes | yes | yes | no
2276 Arguments :
2277 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2278 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002279 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002280
2281 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2282 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2283 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2284 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2285 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2286 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2287 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2288 backlog parameter.
2289
2290 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2291 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2292 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2293
2294 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2295
2296
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002297balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002298balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002299 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2301 yes | no | yes | yes
2302 Arguments :
2303 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2304 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2305 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2306 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2307
2308 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2309 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2310 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2311 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002312 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002313 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002314 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2315 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2316 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2317 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2318 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2319 it, so that you don't worry.
2320
2321 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2322 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2323 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2324 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2325 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2326 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2327 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2328 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002329
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002330 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2331 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2332 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2333 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2334 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2335 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2336 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2337 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2338
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002339 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002340 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002341 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2342 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002343 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002344 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2345 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2346 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2347 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2348 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002349 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2350 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2351 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2352 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2353 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2354 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002355
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002356 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2357 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2358 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2359 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2360 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2361 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2362 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2363 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002364 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002366 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2367 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2368 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002370 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2371 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2372 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2373 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2374 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2375 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2376 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2377 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2378 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2379 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2380 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2381 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002382
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002383 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002384 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2385 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2386 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2387 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2388 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2389 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2390 URIs start with a leading "/".
2391
2392 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2393 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2394 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2395 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2396
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002397 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002398 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2399
2400 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002401 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2402 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002403 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2404 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2405 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2406 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002407 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002408 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2409 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002410
2411 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2412 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2413 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2414 server will receive the request.
2415
2416 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2417 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2418 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2419 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2420 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002421 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2422 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2423 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002425 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2426 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2427 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2428 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2429 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002431 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002432 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2433 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2434 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2435
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002436 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2437 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2438 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2439
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002440 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002441 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002442 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2443 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2444 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2445 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2446 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2447 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002448 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002449 used instead.
2450
2451 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2452 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2453 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2454 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2455
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002456 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2457 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2458 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2459
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002460 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002461
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002462 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002463 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2464 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002465
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002466 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2467 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2468 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002469
2470 Examples :
2471 balance roundrobin
2472 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002473 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002474 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2475 balance hdr(host)
2476 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002477
2478 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2479 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002481 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002482 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2483 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2484 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2485 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2486
2487 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2488 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2489 defaults to 16 kB.
2490
2491 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2492 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2493
2494 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2495 Round Robin.
2496
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002497 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002498 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2499 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2500 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2501
2502 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2503
2504 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002505 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002506 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2507 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2508 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002509
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002510 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511
2512
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002513bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2514bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002515 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2517 no | yes | yes | no
2518 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002519 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2520 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2521 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2522 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002523 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002524 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2525 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2526 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2527 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2528 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2529 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2530 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002531 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2532 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2533 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2534 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2535 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2536 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2537 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002538 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2539 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2540 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002541 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2542 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2543 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002544
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002545 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2546 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002547 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2548 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2549 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002550 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2551 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2552 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2553 the range.
2554
2555 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2556 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2557 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2558 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2559 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2560 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2561 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002562 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002563 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002564
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002565 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2566 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2567 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2568 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2569 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2570 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2571 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2572 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2573
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002574 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2575 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2576 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2577 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002578
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002579 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2580 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2581 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2582 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2583 in a frontend.
2584
2585 Example :
2586 listen http_proxy
2587 bind :80,:443
2588 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002589 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002590
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002591 listen http_https_proxy
2592 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002593 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002594
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002595 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2596 bind ipv6@:80
2597 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2598 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2599
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002600 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002601 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002602
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002603 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2604 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2605 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2606 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2607 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2608
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002609 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002610 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002611
2612
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002613bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002614 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2616 yes | yes | yes | yes
2617 Arguments :
2618 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2619 may be used to override a default value.
2620
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002621 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002622 option may be combined with other numbers.
2623
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002624 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002625 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2626 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2627 missing from all processes.
2628
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002629 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002630 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002631 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2632 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2633 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2634 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2635 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002636 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002637
2638 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2639 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2640 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2641 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2642 and 'even' instances.
2643
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002644 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2645 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2646 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2647 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002648
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002649 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2650 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2651
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002652 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2653 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2654 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2655
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002656 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2657 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2658
2659 Example :
2660 listen app_ip1
2661 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002662 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002663
2664 listen app_ip2
2665 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002666 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002667
2668 listen management
2669 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002670 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002671
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002672 listen management
2673 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2674 bind-process 1-4
2675
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002676 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002677
2678
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002679block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002680 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2682 no | yes | yes | yes
2683
2684 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2685 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002686 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002687 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002688 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002689 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2690 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2691 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002693 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2694 "http-request deny" instead.
2695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002696 Example:
2697 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2698 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2699 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002700 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2701 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2702 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002704 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2705 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2706 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707
2708capture cookie <name> len <length>
2709 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2711 no | yes | yes | no
2712 Arguments :
2713 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2714 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2715 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2716 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2717 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2718
2719 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2720 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2721 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2722 right if it exceeds <length>.
2723
2724 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2725 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2726 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2727 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2728
2729 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2730 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2731 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2732
2733 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2734 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2735 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002736 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2737 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2738 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002739
2740 Example:
2741 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2742
2743 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002744 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002745
2746
2747capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002748 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2750 no | yes | yes | no
2751 Arguments :
2752 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002753 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002754 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2755 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2756 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2757
2758 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2759 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2760 it exceeds <length>.
2761
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002762 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2764 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002765 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2766 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2767 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2768 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002769 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002770 environments to find where the request came from.
2771
2772 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2773 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2774 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2775 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002776
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002777 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2778 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2779 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2780 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2781 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002782
2783 Example:
2784 capture request header Host len 15
2785 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002786 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002787
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002788 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002789 about logging.
2790
2791
2792capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002793 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2795 no | yes | yes | no
2796 Arguments :
2797 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002798 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2800 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2801 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2802
2803 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2804 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2805 it exceeds <length>.
2806
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002807 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002808 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2809 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2810 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002811 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2812 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2813 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2814 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002815
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002816 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2817 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2818 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2819 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2820 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821
2822 Example:
2823 capture response header Content-length len 9
2824 capture response header Location len 15
2825
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002826 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002827 about logging.
2828
2829
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002830clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002831 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2833 yes | yes | yes | no
2834 Arguments :
2835 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2836 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2837 as explained at the top of this document.
2838
2839 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2840 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2841 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2842 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2843 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2844 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2845 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2846 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002847 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002848 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2849 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2850
2851 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2852 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2853 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2854 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2855 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2856 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2857
2858 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2859 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2860
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002861 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2862 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002863
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002864compression algo <algorithm> ...
2865compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002866compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002867 Enable HTTP compression.
2868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2869 yes | yes | yes | yes
2870 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002871 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2872 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2873 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2874
2875 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002876 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2877 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2878 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002879
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002880 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002881 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002882
2883 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2884 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2885 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2886 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2887 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002888 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002889
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002890 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2891 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2892 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2893 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2894 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2895 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2896 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002897 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002898
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002899 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002900 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002901 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2902 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2903 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2904 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2905 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002906
2907 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2908 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2909 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2910 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2911 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002912 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2913 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2914 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2915 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2916 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002917 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2918 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002919
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002920 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002921 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2922 "Accept-Encoding" header
2923 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002924 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002925 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2926 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002927 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2928 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2929 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2930 "multipart"
2931 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2932 header
2933 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2934 and later
2935 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2936 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002937
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002938 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2939 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002940
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002941 Examples :
2942 compression algo gzip
2943 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002944
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002945
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002946contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002947 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2949 yes | no | yes | yes
2950 Arguments :
2951 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2952 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2953 as explained at the top of this document.
2954
2955 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002956 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002957 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002958 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2959 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2960 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2961 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2962
2963 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2964 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2965 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2966 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2967 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2968 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2969
2970 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2971 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2972 instead.
2973
2974 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2975 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2976
2977
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002978cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002979 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2980 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002981 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002982 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2984 yes | no | yes | yes
2985 Arguments :
2986 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2987 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2988 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2989 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2990 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2991 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2992 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2993 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2994 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2995
2996 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2997 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2998 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2999 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3000 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3001 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003002 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3003 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
3004 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
3005 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3006 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003007
3008 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003009 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003010
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003011 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003012 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3013 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
3014 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
3015 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3016 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3017 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3018 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3019 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3020 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3021 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003022
3023 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3024 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3025 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3026 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3027 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3028 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3029 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3030 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3031 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003032 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003033 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3034 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3035 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003036
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003037 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3038 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3039 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003040 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3041 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3042 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3043 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003044 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3045 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3046 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003047
3048 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3049 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3050 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3051 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3052 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3053 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3054 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3055 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3056 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3057
3058 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3059 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3060 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3061 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3062 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3063 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3064 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3065 persistence cookie in the cache.
3066 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3067
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003068 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3069 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3070 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3071 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3072 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
3073 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
3074 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3075 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3076 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3077 they logout.
3078
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003079 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3080 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3081 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3082 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3083
3084 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3085 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3086 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3087 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3088 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3089 this attribute.
3090
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003091 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003092 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003093 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3094 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3095 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3096 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3097 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3098 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003099
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003100 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3101 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3102 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3103 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3104 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3105 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3106 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3107 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3108 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
3109 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3110 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3111 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3112 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3113 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3114 the site.
3115
3116 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3117 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3118 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3119 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3120 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3121 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3122 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3123 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3124 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3125 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3126 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3127 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3128 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3129 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
3130 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3131 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3132
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003133 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3134 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3135 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3136 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3137 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3138 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3139
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003140 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3141 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3142 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3143 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003144
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145 Examples :
3146 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3147 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3148 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003149 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003150
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003151 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003152
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003153
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003154declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3155 Declares a capture slot.
3156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3157 no | yes | yes | no
3158 Arguments:
3159 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3160
3161 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3162 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3163 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3164 for use in the response.
3165
3166 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003167 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003168 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3169
3170
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003171default-server [param*]
3172 Change default options for a server in a backend
3173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3174 yes | no | yes | yes
3175 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003176 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3177 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3178 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3179 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003180
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003181 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003182 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3183
3184 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003185
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003186
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003187default_backend <backend>
3188 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3190 yes | yes | yes | no
3191 Arguments :
3192 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3193
3194 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3195 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3196 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3197 will catch all undetermined requests.
3198
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003199 Example :
3200
3201 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3202 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3203 default_backend dynamic
3204
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003205 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003206
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003207
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003208description <string>
3209 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3211 no | yes | yes | yes
3212 Arguments : string
3213
3214 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3215 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3216 it describes.
3217 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3218
3219
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003220disabled
3221 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3223 yes | yes | yes | yes
3224 Arguments : none
3225
3226 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3227 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3228 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3229 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3230 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3231 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3232 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3233
3234 See also : "enabled"
3235
3236
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003237dispatch <address>:<port>
3238 Set a default server address
3239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3240 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003241 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003242
3243 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3244 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3245 during start-up.
3246
3247 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3248 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3249 possible with normal servers.
3250
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003251 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003252 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3253 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3254 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3255 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3256
3257 See also : "server"
3258
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003259
3260dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3261 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3263 yes | no | yes | yes
3264 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3265
3266 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3267 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3268 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3269 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3270 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3271 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003272
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003273enabled
3274 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3276 yes | yes | yes | yes
3277 Arguments : none
3278
3279 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3280 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3281
3282 See also : "disabled"
3283
3284
3285errorfile <code> <file>
3286 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3288 yes | yes | yes | yes
3289 Arguments :
3290 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003291 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3292 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003293
3294 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003295 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003297 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3298 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003299
3300 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3301 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3302 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3303
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003304 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3305
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003306 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3307 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3308 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3309 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3310
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003311 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3312 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3313 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3314 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3315 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3316 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3317
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003318 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3319 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3320 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003321 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003322 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3323
3324 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3325
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003326 Example :
3327 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003328 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003329 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3330 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3331
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003332
3333errorloc <code> <url>
3334errorloc302 <code> <url>
3335 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3337 yes | yes | yes | yes
3338 Arguments :
3339 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003340 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3341 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003342
3343 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3344 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3345 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3346 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3347 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3348
3349 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3350 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3351 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3352
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003353 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3354
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003355 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3356 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3357 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3358 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003359 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003360 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3361 request.
3362
3363 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3364
3365
3366errorloc303 <code> <url>
3367 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3369 yes | yes | yes | yes
3370 Arguments :
3371 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003372 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3373 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003374
3375 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3376 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3377 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3378 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3379 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3380
3381 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3382 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3383 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3384
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003385 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3386
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003387 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3388 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3389 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3390 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003391 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003392
3393 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3394
3395
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003396email-alert from <emailaddr>
3397 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3398 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3399 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3400 yes | yes | yes | yes
3401
3402 Arguments :
3403
3404 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3405
3406 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3407 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3408
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003409 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003410 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3411 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003412
3413
3414email-alert level <level>
3415 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3416 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3417 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3418 yes | yes | yes | yes
3419
3420 Arguments :
3421
3422 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3423 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3424 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3425
3426 By default level is alert
3427
3428 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3429 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3430 for the proxy.
3431
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003432 Alerts are sent when :
3433
3434 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3435 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3436 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3437 is notice or lower
3438 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3439 and a health check status update occurs
3440
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003441 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3442 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003443 section 3.6 about mailers.
3444
3445
3446email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3447 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3448 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3449 yes | yes | yes | yes
3450
3451 Arguments :
3452
3453 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3454
3455 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3456 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3457
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003458 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3459 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003460
3461
3462email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3463 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3464 mailers.
3465 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3466 yes | yes | yes | yes
3467
3468 Arguments :
3469
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003470 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003471
3472 By default the systems hostname is used.
3473
3474 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3475 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3476 for the proxy.
3477
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003478 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3479 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003480
3481
3482email-alert to <emailaddr>
3483 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3484 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3485 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3486 yes | yes | yes | yes
3487
3488 Arguments :
3489
3490 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3491
3492 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3493 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3494
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003495 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003496 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3497
3498
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003499force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3500 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3501 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3502 no | yes | yes | yes
3503
3504 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3505 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3506 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3507 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3508 marked down for maintenance operations.
3509
3510 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3511 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3512 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3513 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3514 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3515 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3516 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3517 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3518 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3519
3520 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3521 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3522 is used.
3523
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003524 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003525 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003526
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003527
3528filter <name> [param*]
3529 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3531 no | yes | yes | yes
3532 Arguments :
3533 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3534 referenced in section 9.
3535
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003536 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003537 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003538 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3539 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003540
3541 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3542 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3543
3544 Example:
3545 listen
3546 bind *:80
3547
3548 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3549 filter compression
3550 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3551
3552 compression algo gzip
3553 compression offload
3554
3555 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3556
3557 See also : section 9.
3558
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003559
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003560fullconn <conns>
3561 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3563 yes | no | yes | yes
3564 Arguments :
3565 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3566 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3567
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003568 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003569 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003570 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003571 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3572 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3573 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3574 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3575 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003576 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003577
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003578 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3579 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003580 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3581 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3582 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003583
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003584 Example :
3585 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3586 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3587 # connections.
3588 backend dynamic
3589 fullconn 10000
3590 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3591 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3592
3593 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3594
3595
3596grace <time>
3597 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003599 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003600 Arguments :
3601 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3602 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3603 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3604
3605 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3606 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003607 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003608 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3609
3610 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3611 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3612 simplify it.
3613
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003614
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003615hash-balance-factor <factor>
3616 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 yes | no | no | yes
3619 Arguments :
3620 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3621 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3622 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3623
3624 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3625 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3626 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3627 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3628 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3629 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3630 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3631
3632 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3633 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3634 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3635 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3636 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3637
3638 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3639
3640
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003641hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003642 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3644 yes | no | yes | yes
3645 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003646 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3647 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003648
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003649 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3650 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3651 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3652 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3653 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3654 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3655 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3656 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3657 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3658 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003659
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003660 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3661 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3662 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3663 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3664 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3665 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3666 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3667 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3668 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3669 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3670 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3671 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3672 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003673 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3674 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003675
3676 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3677
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003678 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003679 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3680 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3681 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003682 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3683 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3684 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003685
3686 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3687 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003688 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3689 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3690 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3691 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3692
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003693 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3694 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3695 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3696 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3697 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3698 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3699 parameter.
3700
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003701 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3702 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3703 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3704 used on strings.
3705
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003706 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3707
3708 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3709 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3710 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3711 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3712 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3713 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3714 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3715 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3716 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3717 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3718 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3719 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003720
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003721 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3722 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3723 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003724
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003725 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003726
3727
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003728http-check disable-on-404
3729 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003731 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003732 Arguments : none
3733
3734 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3735 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3736 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3737 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3738 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3739 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3740 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3741 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003742 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3743 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3744 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3745
3746 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3747
3748
3749http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003750 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003752 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003753 Arguments :
3754 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3755 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003756 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003757 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3758 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3759 details on the supported keywords.
3760
3761 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3762 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3763 with the usual backslash ('\').
3764
3765 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3766 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3767 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3768 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3769 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3770
3771 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003772 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003773 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3774 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3775 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3776
3777 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003778 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003779 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3780 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3781 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3782 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3783
3784 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003785 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003786 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3787 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3788 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3789 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3790 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3791 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3792 trace).
3793
3794 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003795 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003796 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3797 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3798 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3799 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3800 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3801 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3802
3803 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3804 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3805 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3806 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3807 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3808 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3809 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3810 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3811
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003812 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3813 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3814 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3815
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003816 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3817 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3818
3819 Examples :
3820 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003821 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003822
3823 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003824 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003825
3826 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003827 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003828
3829 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003830 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003831
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003832 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003833
3834
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003835http-check send-state
3836 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3838 yes | no | yes | yes
3839 Arguments : none
3840
3841 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3842 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3843 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3844 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3845 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3846
3847 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3848 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3849 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3850 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3851 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003852 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3853 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3854 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3855
3856 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3857 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3858 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3859
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003860 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3861 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3862 checked in multiple backends.
3863
3864 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3865 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3866
3867 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3868 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3869 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3870 one fails.
3871
3872 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3873 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3874 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3875
3876 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3877 server's queue.
3878
3879 Example of a header received by the application server :
3880 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3881 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3882
3883 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3884
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003885http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> | reject |
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003886 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003887 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003888 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003889 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003890 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3891 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003892 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3893 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003894 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3895 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3896 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003897 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003898 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003899 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003900 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003901 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003902 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003903 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01003904 send-spoe-group |
3905 cache-use
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003906 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003907 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003908 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3909
3910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3911 no | yes | yes | yes
3912
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003913 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3914 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3915 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3916 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3917 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003918
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003919 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3920 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3921 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3922
3923 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003924 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3925 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3926 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3927 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003928
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003929 - "reject" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes
3930 the connection without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
3931 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an
3932 immediate connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
3933
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003934 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3935 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3936 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003937 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3938 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003939 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3940 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3941 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3942 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3943 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003944 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003945 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3946 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003947
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003948 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3949 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3950 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3951 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3952 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3953
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003954 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3955 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3956 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003957 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3958 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003959
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003960 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3961 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3962 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3963 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3964 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3965 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3966 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3967 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3968
3969 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3970 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3971 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003972 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3973 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003974
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003975 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3976 <name>.
3977
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003978 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3979 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3980 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3981 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3982 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3983 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3984 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3985 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3986
3987 Example:
3988
3989 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3990
3991 applied to:
3992
3993 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3994
3995 outputs:
3996
3997 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3998
3999 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
4000
4001 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4002 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4003 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4004 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4005 header.
4006
4007 Example:
4008
4009 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
4010
4011 applied to:
4012
4013 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
4014
4015 outputs:
4016
4017 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
4018
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004019 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
4020 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
4021 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
4022 it.
4023
4024 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
4025 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
4026 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
4027 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
4028 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
4029 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4030
4031 Example :
4032 # prepend the host name before the path
4033 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
4034
4035 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
4036 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
4037 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
4038 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
4039 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
4040 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
4041 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
4042 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4043
4044 Example :
4045 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4046 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
4047
4048 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
4049 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
4050 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
4051 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
4052 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
4053 "set-query".
4054
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004055 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4056 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4057 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4058 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4059 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4060 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4061 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4062 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4063
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004064 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4065 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4066 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4067 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4068 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4069 another equipment.
4070
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004071 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4072 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4073 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4074 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4075 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4076 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4077 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4078 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4079
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004080 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4081 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4082 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4083 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4084 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4085 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4086 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4087 admin privileges.
4088
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004089 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4090 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4091 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4092 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4093 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4094 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4095 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4096 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4097
4098 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4099 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4100 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4101 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4102 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4103 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4104
4105 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4106 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4107 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4108 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4109 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4110 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4111
4112 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4113 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4114 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4115 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4116 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4117 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4118 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4119 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4120 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4121
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004122 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004123 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4124 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4125 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4126 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4127 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4128 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4129 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4130 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4131 request header" for more information.
4132
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004133 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4134 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4135 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4136 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004137 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4138 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004139
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004140 - cache-use <name> :
4141 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4142
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004143 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4144 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4145 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4146 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4147 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4148 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4149 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4150 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4151 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4152 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4153 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4154 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4155
4156 These actions take one or two arguments :
4157 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4158 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4159 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4160 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4161
4162 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4163 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4164 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4165 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4166
4167 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4168 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4169 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4170 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4171 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4172 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4173 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4174 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4175
4176 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4177 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4178 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4179 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4180 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4181
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004182 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4183 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4184 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4185 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4186 continues.
4187
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004188 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4189 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4190 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4191 the actions evaluation continues.
4192
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004193 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4194 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4195 inline.
4196
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004197 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4198 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004199 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004200 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4201 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004202 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004203 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004204 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004205 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4206 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004207 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004208 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004209 and '_'.
4210
4211 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4212 followed by some converters.
4213
4214 Example:
4215
4216 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4217
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004218 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4219 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4220
4221 Example:
4222
4223 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4224
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004225 - set-src <expr> :
4226 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4227 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4228 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4229 source IP for privacy.
4230
4231 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4232 followed by some converters.
4233
4234 Example:
4235
4236 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4237 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4238
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004239 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4240 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004241
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004242 - set-src-port <expr> :
4243 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4244 expression.
4245
4246 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4247 followed by some converters.
4248
4249 Example:
4250
4251 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4252 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4253
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004254 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4255 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4256 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004257
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004258 - set-dst <expr> :
4259 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4260 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4261 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4262 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4263 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4264
4265 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4266 followed by some converters.
4267
4268 Example:
4269
4270 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4271 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4272
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004273 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4274 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4275
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004276 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4277 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4278 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4279 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4280
4281 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4282 followed by some converters.
4283
4284 Example:
4285
4286 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4287 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4288
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004289 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4290 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4291 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4292
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004293 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4294 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4295 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4296 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4297 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4298 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4299 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4300 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4301 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4302 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4303 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4304 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4305 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4306 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4307 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4308 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4309
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004310
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004311 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4312 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4313 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4314
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004315 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4316 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4317 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4318 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4319 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4320 SPOE agent name must be used.
4321
4322 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4323
4324 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4325 configuration.
4326
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004327 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4328
4329 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4330 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004331 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4332 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4333
4334 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4335 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4336 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4337 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004338
4339 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004340 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4341 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4342 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004343
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004344 http-request allow if nagios
4345 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4346 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4347 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004348
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004349 Example:
4350 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004351 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004352
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004353 Example:
4354 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4355 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004356 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004357 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4358 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4359 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4360 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4361 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4362 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4363
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004364 Example:
4365 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4366 acl add path /addacl
4367 acl del path /delacl
4368
4369 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4370
4371 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4372 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4373
4374 Example:
4375 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4376 acl setmap path /setmap
4377 acl delmap path /delmap
4378
4379 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4380
4381 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4382 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4383
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004384 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4385 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004386
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004387http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004388 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004389 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004390 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4391 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004392 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004393 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4394 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4395 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4396 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004397 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004398 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004399 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004400 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004401 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004402 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004403 silent-drop |
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004404 send-spoe-group |
4405 cache-store
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004406 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004407 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004408 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4409
4410 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 no | yes | yes | yes
4412
4413 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4414 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4415 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4416 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4417 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4418 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4419
4420 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4421 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4422 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4423 current section.
4424
4425 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4426 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4427 rules are evaluated.
4428
4429 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4430 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4431 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4432 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4433 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4434 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4435 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4436
4437 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4438 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4439 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4440 external users.
4441
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004442 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4443 <name>.
4444
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004445 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4446 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4447 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4448 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4449 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4450 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4451 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4452 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4453
4454 Example:
4455
4456 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4457
4458 applied to:
4459
4460 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4461
4462 outputs:
4463
4464 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4465
4466 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4467
4468 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4469 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4470 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4471 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4472 header.
4473
4474 Example:
4475
4476 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4477
4478 applied to:
4479
4480 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4481
4482 outputs:
4483
4484 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4485
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004486 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004487 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4488 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4489 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004490
4491 Example:
4492
4493 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4494 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004495 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4496 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004497
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004498 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4499 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4500 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4501 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4502 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4503 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4504 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4505 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4506
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004507 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4508 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4509 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4510 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4511 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4512 another equipment.
4513
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004514 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4515 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4516 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4517 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4518 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4519 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4520 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4521 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4522
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004523 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4524 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4525 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4526 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4527 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4528 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4529 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4530 admin privileges.
4531
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004532 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4533 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4534 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4535 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4536 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4537 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4538 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4539 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4540
4541 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4542 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4543 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4544 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4545 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4546 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4547
4548 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4549 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4550 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4551 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4552 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4553 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4554
4555 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4556 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4557 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4558 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4559 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4560 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4561 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4562 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4563 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4564
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004565 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4566 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4567 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4568 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4569 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4570 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4571 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4572 response header" for more information.
4573
4574 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4575 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4576 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4577 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4578 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004579 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4580 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004581
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004582 - cache-store <name> :
4583 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
4584
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004585 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4586 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4587 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4588 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4589 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4590 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4591
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004592 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4593 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4594 inline.
4595
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004596 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4597 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004598 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004599 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4600 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004601 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004602 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004603 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004604 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4605 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004606 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004607 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4608 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004609
4610 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4611 followed by some converters.
4612
4613 Example:
4614
4615 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4616
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004617 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4618 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4619
4620 Example:
4621
4622 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4623
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004624 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4625 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4626 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4627 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4628 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4629 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4630 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4631
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004632 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4633 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4634 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4635 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4636 continues.
4637
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004638 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4639 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4640 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4641 the actions evaluation continues.
4642
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004643 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4644 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4645 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4646 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4647 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4648 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4649 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4650 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4651 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4652 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4653 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4654 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4655 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4656 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4657 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4658 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4659
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004660 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4661 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4662 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4663 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4664 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4665 SPOE agent name must be used.
4666
4667 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4668
4669 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4670 configuration.
4671
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004672 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4673
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004674 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004675 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4676 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004677 rules.
4678
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004679 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4680 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4681 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4682 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4683
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004684 Example:
4685 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4686
4687 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4688
4689 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4690 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4691
4692 Example:
4693 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4694
4695 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4696
4697 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4698 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4699
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004700 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4701 ACL usage.
4702
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004703
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004704http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4705 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4706
4707 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4708 yes | no | yes | yes
4709
4710 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4711 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4712 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4713 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4714 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4715 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4716
4717 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4718
4719 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4720 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4721 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4722 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4723 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4724 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4725 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4726 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4727 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4728 not checking any request past the first one.
4729
4730 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4731 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4732 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4733 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4734 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4735 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4736 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4737
4738 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4739 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4740 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4741 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4742 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4743 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4744 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4745 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4746 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4747 downsides of rare connection failures.
4748
4749 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4750 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4751 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4752 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4753 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4754 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4755 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4756 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4757 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4758 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4759 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4760 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4761
4762 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4763 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4764 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4765 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4766
4767 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4768 and are never shared ;
4769
4770 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4771 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4772 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4773 and are never shared ;
4774
4775 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4776 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4777 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4778
4779 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4780 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4781 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4782
4783 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4784
4785
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004786http-send-name-header [<header>]
4787 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4788
4789 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4790 yes | no | yes | yes
4791
4792 Arguments :
4793
4794 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4795
4796 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4797 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4798 is added with the header string proved.
4799
4800 See also : "server"
4801
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004802id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004803 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4805 no | yes | yes | yes
4806 Arguments : none
4807
4808 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4809 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4810 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004811
4812
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004813ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4814 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4815 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4816 no | yes | yes | yes
4817
4818 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4819 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4820 and running).
4821
4822 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4823 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4824 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004825 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004826 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4827
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004828 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4829 "unless" condition is met.
4830
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004831 Example:
4832 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4833 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4834 ignore-persist if url_static
4835
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004836 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4837
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004838load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4839 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4840 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4841 yes | no | yes | yes
4842
4843 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4844 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4845 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4846 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4847 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4848 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4849 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4850 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4851
4852 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4853 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004854 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004855
4856 Arguments:
4857 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4858 named "server-state-file".
4859
4860 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4861 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4862 name is used as a file name.
4863
4864 none don't load any stat for this backend
4865
4866 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004867 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4868 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4869 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4870 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4871 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004872
4873 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4874 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4875
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004876 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004877
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004878 global
4879 stats socket /tmp/socket
4880 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004881
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004882 defaults
4883 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004884
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004885 backend bk
4886 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4887 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004888
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004889
4890 Then one can run :
4891
4892 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4893
4894 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4895
4896 1
4897 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4898 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4899 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4900
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004901 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004902
4903 global
4904 stats socket /tmp/socket
4905 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4906
4907 defaults
4908 load-server-state-from-file local
4909
4910 backend bk
4911 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4912 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4913
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004914
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004915 Then one can run :
4916
4917 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4918
4919 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4920
4921 1
4922 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4923 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4924 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4925
4926 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4927 "show servers state"
4928
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004929
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004930log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004931log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004932no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004933 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4935 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004936
4937 Prefix :
4938 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4939 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4940 prefix does not allow arguments.
4941
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004942 Arguments :
4943 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4944 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4945 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4946 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4947 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4948 parameter.
4949
4950 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4951 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4952
4953 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4954 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4955 standard syslog port).
4956
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004957 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4958 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4959 standard syslog port).
4960
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004961 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4962 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4963 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4964 appropriately writeable).
4965
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004966 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4967 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004968
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004969 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4970 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4971 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4972 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4973 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4974 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4975 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4976 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4977 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4978 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4979 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4980
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004981 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4982
4983 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4984 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4985 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4986
4987 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4988 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4989 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004990 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4991 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4992 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4993 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4994 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004995
4996 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4997
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004998 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4999 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5000 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005001
5002 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5003 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5004 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5005 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5006
5007 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5008 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005009
5010 Example :
5011 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005012 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5013 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005014 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005015
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005016
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005017log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005018 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5019 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5020 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005021
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005022 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5023 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5024 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5025 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5026 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005027
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005028 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5029 "option httplog" directives.
5030
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005031log-format-sd <string>
5032 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5033 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5034 yes | yes | yes | no
5035
5036 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5037 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5038 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5039 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5040 which covers the log format string in depth.
5041
5042 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5043 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5044
5045 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5046 log format to "rfc5424".
5047
5048 Example :
5049 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5050
5051
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005052log-tag <string>
5053 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5054 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5055 yes | yes | yes | yes
5056
5057 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5058 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5059 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5060 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5061 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5062 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5063 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5064 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5065 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005066
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005067max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5068 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5069 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5070 yes | no | yes | yes
5071
5072 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5073 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5074 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5075 servers.
5076
5077 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5078 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5079 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5080 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5081 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
5082 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
5083 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5084 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5085 picking a different server.
5086
5087 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5088 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5089 even if they have to be queued.
5090
5091 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5092 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5093
5094
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005095maxconn <conns>
5096 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5098 yes | yes | yes | no
5099 Arguments :
5100 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5101 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5102 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5103 closes.
5104
5105 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5106 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5107 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5108 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005109 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5110 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5111 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5112 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005113
5114 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5115 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5116 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5117
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005118 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5119
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005120 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5121
5122
5123mode { tcp|http|health }
5124 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5126 yes | yes | yes | yes
5127 Arguments :
5128 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5129 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5130 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5131 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5132
5133 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5134 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5135 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5136 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5137 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5138
5139 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005140 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5141 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5142 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5143 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5144 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5145 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5146 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005147
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005148 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5149 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5150 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005151
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005152 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005153 defaults http_instances
5154 mode http
5155
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005156 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005157
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005158
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005159monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005160 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5162 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005163 Arguments :
5164 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5165 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005166 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005167 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5168 backend and its backup.
5169
5170 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5171 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5172 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5173 servers in a list of backends.
5174
5175 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5176 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5177 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5178 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5179 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5180 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5181 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005182 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5183 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005184
5185 Example:
5186 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005187 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005188 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5189 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5190 monitor-uri /site_alive
5191 monitor fail if site_dead
5192
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005193 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005194
5195
5196monitor-net <source>
5197 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5199 yes | yes | yes | no
5200 Arguments :
5201 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5202 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5203 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5204 followed by a mask.
5205
5206 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5207 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005208 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005209 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5210
5211 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5212 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5213 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5214 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005215 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5216 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5217 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005218
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005219 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5220 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5221 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5222 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5223 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5224 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005225
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005226 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5227 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005228
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005229 Example :
5230 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5231 frontend www
5232 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5233
5234 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5235
5236
5237monitor-uri <uri>
5238 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5240 yes | yes | yes | no
5241 Arguments :
5242 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5243 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5244
5245 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5246 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5247 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5248 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5249 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5250 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5251 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5252 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5253
5254 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5255 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5256 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5257 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5258 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5259 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5260
5261 Example :
5262 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5263 frontend www
5264 mode http
5265 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5266
5267 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5268
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005269
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005270option abortonclose
5271no option abortonclose
5272 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5274 yes | no | yes | yes
5275 Arguments : none
5276
5277 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5278 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5279 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5280 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005281 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005282 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5283 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5284 encountered while delivering the response.
5285
5286 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5287 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5288 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5289 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5290 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5291 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005292 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005293 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005294 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005295 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5296 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5297 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5298
5299 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5300 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5301 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5302 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5303 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5304 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5305 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5306 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005307 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005308
5309 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5310 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5311
5312 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5313
5314
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005315option accept-invalid-http-request
5316no option accept-invalid-http-request
5317 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5319 yes | yes | yes | no
5320 Arguments : none
5321
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005322 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005323 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5324 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5325 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5326 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5327 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5328 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5329 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005330 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5331 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5332 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5333 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5334 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005335 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005336 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5337 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5338 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005339
5340 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5341 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5342 been confirmed.
5343
5344 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5345 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005346 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5347 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005348 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5349
5350 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5351 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5352
5353 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5354 stats socket.
5355
5356
5357option accept-invalid-http-response
5358no option accept-invalid-http-response
5359 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5361 yes | no | yes | yes
5362 Arguments : none
5363
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005364 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005365 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5366 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5367 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5368 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5369 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5370 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5371 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005372 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5373 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5374 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005375
5376 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5377 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5378 been confirmed.
5379
5380 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5381 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5382 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5383 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5384
5385 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5386 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5387
5388 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5389 stats socket.
5390
5391
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005392option allbackups
5393no option allbackups
5394 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5396 yes | no | yes | yes
5397 Arguments : none
5398
5399 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5400 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5401 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5402 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5403 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5404 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5405 order between the backup servers anymore.
5406
5407 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5408 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5409
5410 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5411 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5412
5413
5414option checkcache
5415no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005416 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5418 yes | no | yes | yes
5419 Arguments : none
5420
5421 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5422 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005423 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005424 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5425 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005426 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005427
5428 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005429 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005430 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005431 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5432 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005433 to the client are :
5434 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005435 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005436 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005437 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5438 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5439 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5440 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5441 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5442 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5443 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5444 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5445 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5446 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5447 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5448
5449 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005450 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005451 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005452 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005453 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5454
5455 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5456 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005457 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005458 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5459
5460 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5461 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5462
5463
5464option clitcpka
5465no option clitcpka
5466 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5468 yes | yes | yes | no
5469 Arguments : none
5470
5471 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5472 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5473 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5474 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5475
5476 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5477 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5478 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5479 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5480
5481 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5482 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5483 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5484 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5485 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5486
5487 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5488
5489 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5490 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5491 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5492
5493 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5494 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5495
5496 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5497
5498
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005499option contstats
5500 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5502 yes | yes | yes | no
5503 Arguments : none
5504
5505 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5506 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5507 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5508 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005509 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5510 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5511 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5512 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5513 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005514
5515
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005516option dontlog-normal
5517no option dontlog-normal
5518 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5520 yes | yes | yes | no
5521 Arguments : none
5522
5523 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5524 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5525 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5526 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5527 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5528 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5529 logged.
5530
5531 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5532 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5533 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005535 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005536 logging.
5537
5538
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005539option dontlognull
5540no option dontlognull
5541 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5543 yes | yes | yes | no
5544 Arguments : none
5545
5546 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5547 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5548 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5549 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5550 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5551 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005552 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5553 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5554 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005555
5556 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5557 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5558 would not be logged.
5559
5560 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5561 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5562
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005563 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5564 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005565
5566
5567option forceclose
5568no option forceclose
5569 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005571 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005572 Arguments : none
5573
5574 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5575 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5576 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5577 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5578 global session times in the logs.
5579
5580 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005581 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005582 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005583
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005584 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5585 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5586 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5587
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005588 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5589 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005590
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005591 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5592 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5593
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005594 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005595
5596
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005597option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005598 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5600 yes | yes | yes | yes
5601 Arguments :
5602 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5603 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005604 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005605 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005606
5607 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5608 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5609 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5610 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5611 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5612 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5613 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005614 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5615 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5616 possible that the client has already brought one.
5617
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005618 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005619 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005620 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5621 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005622 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5623 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005624
5625 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5626 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5627 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5628 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5629 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5630 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5631 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5632
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005633 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5634 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5635 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5636 are under the control of the end-user.
5637
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005638 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005639 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5640 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005641 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5642 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5643 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005644
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005645 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005646 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5647 frontend www
5648 mode http
5649 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5650
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005651 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5652 backend www
5653 mode http
5654 option forwardfor header X-Client
5655
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005656 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005657 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005658
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005659
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005660option http-buffer-request
5661no option http-buffer-request
5662 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5664 yes | yes | yes | yes
5665 Arguments : none
5666
5667 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5668 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5669 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5670 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5671 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5672 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5673 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5674 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005675 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005676 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5677 default.
5678
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005679 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005680
5681
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005682option http-ignore-probes
5683no option http-ignore-probes
5684 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5686 yes | yes | yes | no
5687 Arguments : none
5688
5689 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5690 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5691 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5692 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5693 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5694 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5695 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5696 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5697 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5698 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5699 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5700 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5701
5702 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5703 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5704 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5705 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5706 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5707 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5708 are often the only way to detect them.
5709
5710 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5711 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5712
5713 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5714
5715
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005716option http-keep-alive
5717no option http-keep-alive
5718 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5720 yes | yes | yes | yes
5721 Arguments : none
5722
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005723 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5724 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5725 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5726 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5727 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5728 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5729 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5730
5731 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5732 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005733 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5734 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5735 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5736 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5737 situations where this option may be useful :
5738
5739 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5740 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5741
5742 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5743 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5744
5745 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5746 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5747 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5748 request.
5749
5750 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5751 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005752 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5753 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5754 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005755
5756 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5757 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5758
5759 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5760 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5761 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5762 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5763 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5764 not set.
5765
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005766 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5767 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005768 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005769 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005770
5771 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005772 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5773 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005774
5775
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005776option http-no-delay
5777no option http-no-delay
5778 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5779 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5780 yes | yes | yes | yes
5781 Arguments : none
5782
5783 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5784 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5785 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5786 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5787 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5788 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5789 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5790 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5791 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5792 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5793 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5794 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5795 affected.
5796
5797 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5798 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5799 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5800 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5801 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5802 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5803 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5804 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5805 latency environments.
5806
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005807 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5808
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005809
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005810option http-pretend-keepalive
5811no option http-pretend-keepalive
5812 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5814 yes | yes | yes | yes
5815 Arguments : none
5816
5817 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5818 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5819 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5820 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5821 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5822 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5823 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5824 consider the response complete.
5825
5826 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5827 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5828 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5829 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5830 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5831 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5832
5833 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5834 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5835 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5836 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5837 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5838 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5839 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5840
5841 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5842 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005843 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005844 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5845 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005846
5847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5849
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005850 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5851 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005852
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005853
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005854option http-server-close
5855no option http-server-close
5856 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5858 yes | yes | yes | yes
5859 Arguments : none
5860
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005861 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5862 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5863 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5864 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5865 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5866 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5867 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5868 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5869 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5870 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5871 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005872 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005873 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5874 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5875 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5876 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005877
5878 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5879 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5880 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5881 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005882 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5883 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005884
5885 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5886 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005887 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5888 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005889 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5890 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005891
5892 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5893 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5894
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005895 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005896 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5897 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005898
5899
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005900option http-tunnel
5901no option http-tunnel
5902 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5904 yes | yes | yes | yes
5905 Arguments : none
5906
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005907 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5908 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5909 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5910 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5911 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5912 "option http-tunnel".
5913
5914 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005915 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005916 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5917 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5918 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5919 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5920 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5921 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5922 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005923
5924 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5925 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5926
5927 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5928 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5929 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5930
5931
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005932option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005933no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005934 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5936 yes | yes | yes | no
5937 Arguments : none
5938
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005939 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005940 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5941 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5942 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5943 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5944 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5945 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5946
5947 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5948 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005949 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5950 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5951 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005952
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005953 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5954 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5955 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5956 front of an existing proxy.
5957
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005958 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5959
5960 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5961 http-server-close".
5962
5963
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005964option httpchk
5965option httpchk <uri>
5966option httpchk <method> <uri>
5967option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5968 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5970 yes | no | yes | yes
5971 Arguments :
5972 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5973 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5974 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5975 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5976 ones.
5977
5978 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5979 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5980 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5981
5982 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5983 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5984 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5985 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5986 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5987
5988 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5989 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5990 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5991 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5992 the lack of any response.
5993
5994 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5995
5996 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5997 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5998 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5999
6000 Examples :
6001 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6002 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6003 backend https_relay
6004 mode tcp
6005 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6006 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6007
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006008 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6009 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6010 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006011
6012
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006013option httpclose
6014no option httpclose
6015 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
6016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6017 yes | yes | yes | yes
6018 Arguments : none
6019
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006020 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6021 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6022 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6023 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006024 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006025 "option http-tunnel".
6026
6027 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
6028 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
6029 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
6030 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
6031 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
6032 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
6033 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
6034 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006035
6036 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006037 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01006038 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
6039 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
6040 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
6041 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
6042 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006043
6044 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6045 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006046 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
6047 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006048 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
6049 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006050
6051 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6052 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6053
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02006054 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
6055 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006056
6057
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006058option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006059 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6061 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006062 Arguments :
6063 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6064 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6065 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
6066 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
6067 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006068
6069 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6070 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6071 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6072 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6073 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6074 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6075 ports.
6076
6077 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6078
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006079 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6080 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006081
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006082 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006084 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006085
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006086
6087option http_proxy
6088no option http_proxy
6089 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6091 yes | yes | yes | yes
6092 Arguments : none
6093
6094 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6095 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6096 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6097 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6098 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6099
6100 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6101 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006102 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6103 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006104
6105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6107
6108 Example :
6109 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6110 backend direct_forward
6111 option httpclose
6112 option http_proxy
6113
6114 See also : "option httpclose"
6115
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006116
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006117option independent-streams
6118no option independent-streams
6119 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6121 yes | yes | yes | yes
6122 Arguments : none
6123
6124 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6125 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6126 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6127 receive data or not.
6128
6129 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
6130 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6131 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6132 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6133 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6134 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6135 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6136 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6137 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6138 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6139 socket buffers.
6140
6141 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6142 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6143 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6144 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6145 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6146
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006147 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006148 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6149 deprecated.
6150
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006151 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006152
6153
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006154option ldap-check
6155 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6157 yes | no | yes | yes
6158 Arguments : none
6159
6160 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6161 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6162 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6163 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6164
6165 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6166 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6167
6168 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6169 configure it.
6170
6171 Example :
6172 option ldap-check
6173
6174 See also : "option httpchk"
6175
6176
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006177option external-check
6178 Use external processes for server health checks
6179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6180 yes | no | yes | yes
6181
6182 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6183 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6184 command".
6185
6186 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6187
6188 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6189
6190
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006191option log-health-checks
6192no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006193 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6195 yes | no | yes | yes
6196 Arguments : none
6197
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006198 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6199 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6200 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006201
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006202 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6203 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6204 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6205 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6206 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6207
6208 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6209 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006210
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006211 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6212 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6213 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006214
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006215
6216option log-separate-errors
6217no option log-separate-errors
6218 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6220 yes | yes | yes | no
6221 Arguments : none
6222
6223 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6224 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6225 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6226 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6227 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6228 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6229 provides very important information.
6230
6231 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6232 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6233 error logs.
6234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006235 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006236 logging.
6237
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006238
6239option logasap
6240no option logasap
6241 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6243 yes | yes | yes | no
6244 Arguments : none
6245
6246 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6247 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6248 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6249 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6250 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6251 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6252 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006253 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006254 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6255 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6256
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006257 Examples :
6258 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6259 mode http
6260 option httplog
6261 option logasap
6262 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6263
6264 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6265 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6266 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6267 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6268
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006269 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006270 logging.
6271
6272
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006273option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006274 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6276 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006277 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006278 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6279 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006280 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006281
6282 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6283 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6284 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6285 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6286 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6287 in the MySQL table, like this :
6288
6289 USE mysql;
6290 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6291 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6292
6293 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6294 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6295 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6296 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6297 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6298 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6299 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6300 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6301 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6302
6303 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6304 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006305
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006306 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006307
6308 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6309 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6310 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6311 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006312 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6313 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006314
6315 See also: "option httpchk"
6316
6317
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006318option nolinger
6319no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006320 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6322 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006323 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006324
6325 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6326 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6327 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6328 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6329 connections.
6330
6331 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6332 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6333 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6334 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6335 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6336 this too.
6337
6338 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6339 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6340 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6341
6342 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6343 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6344 for servers.
6345
6346 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6347 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6348
6349
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006350option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6351 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6353 yes | yes | yes | yes
6354 Arguments :
6355 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6356 matching <network>
6357 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6358 header name.
6359
6360 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6361 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6362 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6363 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6364 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6365 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6366 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6367 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6368 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6369 possible that the client has already brought one.
6370
6371 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6372 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6373 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6374 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6375 header and requires different one.
6376
6377 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6378 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6379 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6380 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6381 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6382 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6383 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6384
6385 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6386 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6387 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6388 both are defined.
6389
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006390 Examples :
6391 # Original Destination address
6392 frontend www
6393 mode http
6394 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6395
6396 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6397 backend www
6398 mode http
6399 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6400
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006401 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6402 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006403
6404
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006405option persist
6406no option persist
6407 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6408 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6409 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006410 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006411
6412 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6413 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6414 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6415 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6416 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6417 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6418 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6419 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6420 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6421 redirected to another valid server.
6422
6423 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6424 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6425
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006426 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006427
6428
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006429option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6430 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6432 yes | no | yes | yes
6433 Arguments :
6434 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6435 PostgreSQL server.
6436
6437 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6438 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6439 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6440 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6441
6442 See also: "option httpchk"
6443
6444
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006445option prefer-last-server
6446no option prefer-last-server
6447 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6448 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6449 yes | no | yes | yes
6450 Arguments : none
6451
6452 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6453 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6454 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6455 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6456 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6457 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6458 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6459 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6460 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006461 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6462 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6463 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6464 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6465 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6466 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6467 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006468
6469 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6470 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6471
6472 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6473
6474
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006475option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006476option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006477no option redispatch
6478 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6479 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6480 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006481 Arguments :
6482 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6483 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6484 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6485 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6486 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6487 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6488 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6489 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6490 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6491
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006492
6493 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6494 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6495 be able to access the service anymore.
6496
6497 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6498 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6499
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006500 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006501 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6502 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006503
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006504 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6505 "redisp" keywords.
6506
6507 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6508 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6509
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006510 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006511
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006512
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006513option redis-check
6514 Use redis health checks for server testing
6515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6516 yes | no | yes | yes
6517 Arguments : none
6518
6519 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6520 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6521 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6522 find the "+PONG" response message.
6523
6524 Example :
6525 option redis-check
6526
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006527 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006528
6529
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006530option smtpchk
6531option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6532 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6534 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006535 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006536 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6537 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6538 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6539
6540 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6541 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6542 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6543
6544 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6545 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6546 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6547 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6548 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6549 dead server.
6550
6551 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6552 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6553 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6554 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6555
6556 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6557 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6558 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6559 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006560 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006561
6562 Example :
6563 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6564
6565 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006568option socket-stats
6569no option socket-stats
6570
6571 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6573 yes | yes | yes | no
6574
6575 Arguments : none
6576
6577
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006578option splice-auto
6579no option splice-auto
6580 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6582 yes | yes | yes | yes
6583 Arguments : none
6584
6585 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6586 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6587 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6588 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006589 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006590 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6591 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6592 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6593 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6594
6595 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6596 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6597 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6598 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6599 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6600 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6601 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6602 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6603 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6604 keyword.
6605
6606 Example :
6607 option splice-auto
6608
6609 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6610 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6611
6612 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6613 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6614
6615
6616option splice-request
6617no option splice-request
6618 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6620 yes | yes | yes | yes
6621 Arguments : none
6622
6623 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006624 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006625 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6626 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6627 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6628 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6629
6630 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6631
6632 Example :
6633 option splice-request
6634
6635 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6636 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6637
6638 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6639 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6640
6641
6642option splice-response
6643no option splice-response
6644 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6646 yes | yes | yes | yes
6647 Arguments : none
6648
6649 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006650 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006651 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6652 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6653 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6654 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6655
6656 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6657
6658 Example :
6659 option splice-response
6660
6661 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6662 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6663
6664 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6665 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6666
6667
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006668option spop-check
6669 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6671 no | no | no | yes
6672 Arguments : none
6673
6674 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6675 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6676 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6677 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6678
6679 Example :
6680 option spop-check
6681
6682 See also : "option httpchk"
6683
6684
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006685option srvtcpka
6686no option srvtcpka
6687 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6689 yes | no | yes | yes
6690 Arguments : none
6691
6692 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6693 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6694 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6695 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6696
6697 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6698 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6699 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6700 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6701
6702 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6703 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6704 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6705 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6706 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6707
6708 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6709
6710 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6711 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6712 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6713
6714 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6715 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6716
6717 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6718
6719
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006720option ssl-hello-chk
6721 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6723 yes | no | yes | yes
6724 Arguments : none
6725
6726 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6727 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6728 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6729 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6730 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6731 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6732 hello message.
6733
6734 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6735 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6736 messages, which is appreciable.
6737
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006738 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6739 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6740 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006741
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006742 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6743
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006744
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006745option tcp-check
6746 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6747 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6748 yes | no | yes | yes
6749
6750 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6751 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6752
6753 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6754 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6755 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6756
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006757 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006758 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6759 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6760 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6761 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6762 only.
6763
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006764 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006765 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6766 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6767 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6768 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6769
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006770 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006771 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6772 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006773 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006774 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6775 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6776 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6777 the respective protocols.
6778 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6779 analysed.
6780
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006781 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6782 script.
6783
6784 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6785 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6786 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6787 The "comment" is of course optional.
6788
6789
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006790 Examples :
6791 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6792 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006793 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006794
6795 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6796 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006797 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006798
6799 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6800 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006801 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006802 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006803 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006804 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006805 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006806 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006807 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6808 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006809 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006810 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6811 tcp-check expect string +OK
6812
6813 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6814 (send many headers before analyzing)
6815 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006816 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006817 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6818 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6819 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6820 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006821 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006822
6823
6824 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6825
6826
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006827option tcp-smart-accept
6828no option tcp-smart-accept
6829 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6831 yes | yes | yes | no
6832 Arguments : none
6833
6834 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6835 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6836 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6837 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6838 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6839 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6840
6841 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6842 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6843 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6844 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6845
6846 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6847 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6848 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6849 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6850
6851 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6852 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6853 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6854
6855 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6856 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6857 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6858
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006859 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6860
6861
6862option tcp-smart-connect
6863no option tcp-smart-connect
6864 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6866 yes | no | yes | yes
6867 Arguments : none
6868
6869 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6870 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6871 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6872 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6873 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6874
6875 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6876 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6877 complex.
6878
6879 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6880 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6881 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6882
6883 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6884 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6885
6886 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6887
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006888
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006889option tcpka
6890 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6892 yes | yes | yes | yes
6893 Arguments : none
6894
6895 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6896 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6897 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6898 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6899
6900 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6901 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6902 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6903 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6904
6905 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6906 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6907 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6908 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6909 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6910
6911 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6912
6913 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6914 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6915 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6916 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6917 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6918 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6919 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6920 backends.
6921
6922 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6923
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006924
6925option tcplog
6926 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6928 yes | yes | yes | yes
6929 Arguments : none
6930
6931 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6932 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6933 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6934 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6935 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6936 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6937 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6938 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6939
6940 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6941
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006942 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6943
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006944 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006945
6946
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006947option transparent
6948no option transparent
6949 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006951 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006952 Arguments : none
6953
6954 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6955 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6956 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6957 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6958 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6959 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6960 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6961 appropriate server.
6962
6963 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6964 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6965
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006966 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006967 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006968
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006969
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006970external-check command <command>
6971 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6973 yes | no | yes | yes
6974
6975 Arguments :
6976 <command> is the external command to run
6977
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006978 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6979
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006980 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006981
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006982 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6983 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6984 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6985 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6986 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6987 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006988
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006989 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6990
6991 Environment variables :
6992 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6993 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6994
6995 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6996
6997 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6998
6999 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7000 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7001 for a UNIX socket).
7002
7003 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7004
7005 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7006
7007 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7008
7009 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7010
7011 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7012
7013 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7014 socket).
7015
7016 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7017 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7018
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007019 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7020 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7021 failed.
7022
7023 Example :
7024 external-check command /bin/true
7025
7026 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7027
7028
7029external-check path <path>
7030 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7032 yes | no | yes | yes
7033
7034 Arguments :
7035 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7036
7037 The default path is "".
7038
7039 Example :
7040 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7041
7042 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7043 "external-check command"
7044
7045
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007046persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007047persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007048 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7050 yes | no | yes | yes
7051 Arguments :
7052 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007053 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7054 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007055
7056 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7057 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
7058 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
7059 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7060 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7061 forwarded to this server.
7062
7063 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7064 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7065 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007066 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007067 a single "listen" section.
7068
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007069 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7070 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7071 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7072
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007073 Example :
7074 listen tse-farm
7075 bind :3389
7076 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7077 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7078 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7079 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7080 persist rdp-cookie
7081 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007082 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007083 balance rdp-cookie
7084 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7085 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7086
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007087 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7088 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007089
7090
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007091rate-limit sessions <rate>
7092 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7094 yes | yes | yes | no
7095 Arguments :
7096 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7097 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7098
7099 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7100 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7101 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7102 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7103 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7104 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7105
7106 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7107 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7108 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7109 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7110
7111 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7112 listen smtp
7113 mode tcp
7114 bind :25
7115 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007116 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007117
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007118 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7119 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7120 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007121
7122 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7123
7124
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007125redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7126redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7127redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007128 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7130 no | yes | yes | yes
7131
7132 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007133 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007134
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007135 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007136 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007137 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7138 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7139 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007140
7141 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7142 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7143 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7144 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7145 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007146 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7147 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7148 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7149 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007150
7151 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7152 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7153 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7154 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7155 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7156 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007157 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007158 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007159 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7160 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7161 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007162
7163 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007164 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7165 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7166 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007167 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007168 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7169 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7170 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7171 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007172
7173 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
7174 expected behaviour of a redirection :
7175
7176 - "drop-query"
7177 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7178 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7179 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7180 with a location-type redirect.
7181
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007182 - "append-slash"
7183 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7184 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7185 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7186 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7187
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007188 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7189 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7190 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7191 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7192 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7193 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7194 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7195
7196 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7197 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7198 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7199 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7200 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7201 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7202 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007203
7204 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7205 acl clear dst_port 80
7206 acl secure dst_port 8080
7207 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007208 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007209 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007210 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7211
7212 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007213 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7214 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7215 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007216 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007217
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007218 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7219 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7220 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7221
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007222 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007223 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007224
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007225 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007226 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7227 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7228 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007230 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007231
7232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007233redisp (deprecated)
7234redispatch (deprecated)
7235 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7236 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7237 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007238 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007239
7240 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7241 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7242 be able to access the service anymore.
7243
7244 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7245 redistribute them to a working server.
7246
7247 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7248 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7249 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007251 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7252 "option redispatch" instead.
7253
7254 See also : "option redispatch"
7255
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007256
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007257reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007258 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7260 no | yes | yes | yes
7261 Arguments :
7262 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7263 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007264 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007265
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007266 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7267 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7268
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007269 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7270 the last header of an HTTP request.
7271
7272 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7273 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7274 responses.
7275
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007276 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7277 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7278 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7279
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007280 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7281 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007282
7283
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007284reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7285reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007286 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7288 no | yes | yes | yes
7289 Arguments :
7290 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7291 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7292 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7293 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7294 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7295 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7296 ignores case.
7297
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007298 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7299 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7300
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007301 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7302 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7303 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7304 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007305 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007306
7307 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7308 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7309
7310 Example :
7311 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7312 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7313 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7314
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007315 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7316 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007317
7318
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007319reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7320reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007321 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7323 no | yes | yes | yes
7324 Arguments :
7325 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7326 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7327 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7328 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7329 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7330 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7331
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007332 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7333 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7334
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007335 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7336 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7337 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7338 next servers.
7339
7340 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7341 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7342 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7343
7344 Example :
7345 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7346 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7347 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7348
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007349 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7350 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007351
7352
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007353reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7354reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007355 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7357 no | yes | yes | yes
7358 Arguments :
7359 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7360 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7361 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7362 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7363 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7364 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7365 case.
7366
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007367 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7368 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7369
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007370 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7371 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7372 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7373 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007374 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007375
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007376 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007377 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007378 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007379
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007380 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7381 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7382
7383 Example :
7384 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7385 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7386 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7387
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007388 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7389 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007390
7391
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007392reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7393reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007394 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7396 no | yes | yes | yes
7397 Arguments :
7398 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7399 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7400 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7401 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7402 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7403 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7404 case.
7405
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007406 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7407 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7408
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007409 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7410 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7411 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7412 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7413
7414 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7415 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7416
7417 Example :
7418 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7419 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7420 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7421 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7422
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007423 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7424 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007425
7426
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007427reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7428reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007429 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7431 no | yes | yes | yes
7432 Arguments :
7433 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7434 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7435 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7436 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7437 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7438 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7439
7440 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7441 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7442 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7443 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007444 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007445
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007446 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7447 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7448
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007449 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7450 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7451 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7452
7453 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7454 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7455 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7456 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7457 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7458
7459 Example :
7460 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007461 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007462 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7463 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7464
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007465 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7466 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007467
7468
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007469reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7470reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007471 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7473 no | yes | yes | yes
7474 Arguments :
7475 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7476 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7477 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7478 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7479 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7480 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7481 ignores case.
7482
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007483 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7484 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7485
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007486 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7487 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007488 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7489 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7490 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007491 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7492 not set.
7493
7494 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7495 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7496 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7497 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7498 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7499
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007500 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007501 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7502 # block all others.
7503 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7504 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7505
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007506 # block bad guys
7507 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7508 reqitarpit . if badguys
7509
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007510 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7511 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007512
7513
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007514retries <value>
7515 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7516 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7517 yes | no | yes | yes
7518 Arguments :
7519 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7520 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7521 default value is 3.
7522
7523 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7524 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7525 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7526
7527 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007528 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7529 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007530
7531 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7532 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7533
7534 See also : "option redispatch"
7535
7536
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007537rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007538 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7540 no | yes | yes | yes
7541 Arguments :
7542 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7543 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007544 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007545
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007546 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7547 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7548
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007549 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7550 the last header of an HTTP response.
7551
7552 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7553 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7554 responses.
7555
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007556 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7557 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007558
7559
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007560rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7561rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007562 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7564 no | yes | yes | yes
7565 Arguments :
7566 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7567 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7568 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7569 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7570 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7571 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7572 ignores case.
7573
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007574 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7575 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7576
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007577 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7578 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007579 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007580 client.
7581
7582 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7583 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7584 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7585
7586 Example :
7587 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007588 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007589
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007590 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7591 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007592
7593
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007594rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7595rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007596 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7598 no | yes | yes | yes
7599 Arguments :
7600 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7601 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7602 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7603 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7604 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7605 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7606 ignores case.
7607
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007608 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7609 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7610
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007611 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7612 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7613 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7614 case-sensitive.
7615
7616 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007617 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7618 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7619 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007620
7621 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7622 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7623
7624 Example :
7625 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7626 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7627
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007628 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7629 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007630
7631
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007632rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7633rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007634 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7636 no | yes | yes | yes
7637 Arguments :
7638 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7639 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7640 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7641 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7642 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7643 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7644 ignores case.
7645
7646 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7647 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7648 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7649 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007650 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007651
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007652 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7653 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7654
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007655 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7656 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7657 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7658
7659 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7660 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7661 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7662 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7663 are not case-sensitive.
7664
7665 Example :
7666 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7667 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7668
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007669 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7670 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007671
7672
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007673server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007674 Declare a server in a backend
7675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7676 no | no | yes | yes
7677 Arguments :
7678 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007679 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007680 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007681
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007682 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7683 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7684 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7685 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007686 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7687 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7688 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7689 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7690 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007691 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7692 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7693 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7694 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7695 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7696 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7697 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007698 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007699 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7700 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007701 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7702 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007703
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007704 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007705 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7706 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7707 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7708 adding this value to the client's port.
7709
7710 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7711 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007712 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007713
7714 Examples :
7715 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7716 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007717 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007718 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7719 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7720 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007721
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007722 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7723 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7724 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7725 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7726 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7727
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007728 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7729 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007730
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007731server-state-file-name [<file>]
7732 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7733 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7734 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7735 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7736 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7737 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7738
7739 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7740 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7741
7742 global
7743 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7744
7745 backend bk
7746 load-server-state-from-file
7747
7748 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7749 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007750
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007751server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7752 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7753 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7755 no | no | yes | yes
7756
7757 Arguments:
7758 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7759
7760 <num | range>
7761 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7762 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7763 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7764 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7765
7766 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7767
7768 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7769
7770 <params*>
7771 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7772 keyword.
7773
7774 Examples:
7775 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7776 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7777 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7778
7779 # or
7780 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7781
7782 # would be equivalent to:
7783 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7784 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7785 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7786
7787
7788
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007789source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007790source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007791source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007792 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7794 yes | no | yes | yes
7795 Arguments :
7796 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7797 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007798
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007799 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007800 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7801 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7802 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7803 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7804 supported prefixes are :
7805 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7806 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7807 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007808 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007809 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7810 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007811
7812 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7813 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007814 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7815 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7816 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007817
7818 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7819 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7820 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7821 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7822 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7823 <addr>.
7824
7825 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7826 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7827 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7828 port.
7829
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007830 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7831 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7832 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7833 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007834 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007835 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7836 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7837 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7838 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7839 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7840 HTTP header.
7841
7842 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7843 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007844 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007845 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7846 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7847 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7848 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7849 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7850 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7851 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7852
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007853 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7854 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7855 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7856 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7857 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7858 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7859
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007860 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7861 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7862 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7863 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7864
7865 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7866 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7867 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7868 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7869 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7870 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7871
7872 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7873 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7874 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7875 there are two methods :
7876
7877 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7878 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7879 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7880 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7881 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7882 of the client ranges may be used.
7883
7884 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7885 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7886 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7887 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7888 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7889 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7890 same session.
7891
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007892 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7893 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7894 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007895 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007896
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007897 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7898
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007899 Examples :
7900 backend private
7901 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7902 source 192.168.1.200
7903
7904 backend transparent_ssl1
7905 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7906 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7907
7908 backend transparent_ssl2
7909 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7910 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7911 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7912
7913 backend transparent_ssl3
7914 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7915 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7916 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7917
7918 backend transparent_smtp
7919 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7920 # with Tproxy version 4.
7921 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7922
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007923 backend transparent_http
7924 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7925 # proxy.
7926 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007928 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007929 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007931
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007932srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7933 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7935 yes | no | yes | yes
7936 Arguments :
7937 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7938 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7939 as explained at the top of this document.
7940
7941 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7942 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7943 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7944 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7945 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7946 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7947 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7948
7949 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7950 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7951 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7952 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7953 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007954 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007955 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007956 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007957
7958 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7959 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7960 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7961 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7962 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7963 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7964
7965 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7966 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7967
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007968 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7969 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007970
7971
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007972stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7973 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007975 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007976
7977 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7978 matched.
7979
7980 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7981 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7982
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007983 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7984 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7985 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7986
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007987 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7988 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7989 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7990 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007991
7992 Example :
7993 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7994 backend stats_localhost
7995 stats enable
7996 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7997
7998 Example :
7999 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8000 backend stats_auth
8001 stats enable
8002 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8003 stats admin if TRUE
8004
8005 Example :
8006 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8007 userlist stats-auth
8008 group admin users admin
8009 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8010 group readonly users haproxy
8011 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8012
8013 backend stats_auth
8014 stats enable
8015 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8016 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8017 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8018 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8019
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008020 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8021 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8022 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008023
8024
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008025stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8026 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008028 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008029 Arguments :
8030 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8031
8032 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8033
8034 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8035 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8036 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8037 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8038 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8039 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8040
8041 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8042 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8043 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008044 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008045
8046 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8047 report using "stats scope".
8048
8049 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8050 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8051 unobvious parameters.
8052
8053 Example :
8054 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8055 backend public_www
8056 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8057 stats enable
8058 stats hide-version
8059 stats scope .
8060 stats uri /admin?stats
8061 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8062 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8063 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8064
8065 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8066 backend private_monitoring
8067 stats enable
8068 stats uri /admin?stats
8069 stats refresh 5s
8070
8071 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8072
8073
8074stats enable
8075 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008077 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008078 Arguments : none
8079
8080 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8081 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8082 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8083 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8084 - stats auth : no authentication
8085 - stats scope : no restriction
8086
8087 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8088 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8089 unobvious parameters.
8090
8091 Example :
8092 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8093 backend public_www
8094 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8095 stats enable
8096 stats hide-version
8097 stats scope .
8098 stats uri /admin?stats
8099 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8100 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8101 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8102
8103 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8104 backend private_monitoring
8105 stats enable
8106 stats uri /admin?stats
8107 stats refresh 5s
8108
8109 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8110
8111
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008112stats hide-version
8113 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008115 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008116 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008117
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008118 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8119 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8120 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8121 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8122 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8123 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008125 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8126 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8127 unobvious parameters.
8128
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008129 Example :
8130 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8131 backend public_www
8132 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008133 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008134 stats hide-version
8135 stats scope .
8136 stats uri /admin?stats
8137 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8138 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8139 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008140
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008141 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8142 backend private_monitoring
8143 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008144 stats uri /admin?stats
8145 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008146
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008147 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008148
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008149
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008150stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8151 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8152 Access control for statistics
8153
8154 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8155 no | no | yes | yes
8156
8157 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8158 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8159 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8160 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8161 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8162 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8163
8164 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8165 instance.
8166
8167 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8168 about ACL usage.
8169
8170
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008171stats realm <realm>
8172 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008174 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008175 Arguments :
8176 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8177 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8178 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8179
8180 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8181 using a backslash ('\').
8182
8183 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8184 only related to authentication.
8185
8186 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8187 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8188 unobvious parameters.
8189
8190 Example :
8191 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8192 backend public_www
8193 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8194 stats enable
8195 stats hide-version
8196 stats scope .
8197 stats uri /admin?stats
8198 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8199 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8200 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8201
8202 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8203 backend private_monitoring
8204 stats enable
8205 stats uri /admin?stats
8206 stats refresh 5s
8207
8208 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8209
8210
8211stats refresh <delay>
8212 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008214 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008215 Arguments :
8216 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8217 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8218 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8219 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8220 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8221 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8222
8223 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8224 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8225 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8226 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8227
8228 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8229 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8230 unobvious parameters.
8231
8232 Example :
8233 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8234 backend public_www
8235 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8236 stats enable
8237 stats hide-version
8238 stats scope .
8239 stats uri /admin?stats
8240 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8241 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8242 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8243
8244 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8245 backend private_monitoring
8246 stats enable
8247 stats uri /admin?stats
8248 stats refresh 5s
8249
8250 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8251
8252
8253stats scope { <name> | "." }
8254 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008256 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008257 Arguments :
8258 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8259 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8260 section in which the statement appears.
8261
8262 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8263 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8264 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8265 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8266 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8267 exists.
8268
8269 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8270 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8271 unobvious parameters.
8272
8273 Example :
8274 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8275 backend public_www
8276 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8277 stats enable
8278 stats hide-version
8279 stats scope .
8280 stats uri /admin?stats
8281 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8282 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8283 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8284
8285 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8286 backend private_monitoring
8287 stats enable
8288 stats uri /admin?stats
8289 stats refresh 5s
8290
8291 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8292
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008293
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008294stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008295 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008297 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008298
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008299 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008300 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8301
8302 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8303 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8304
8305 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8306 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008307 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008308
8309 Example :
8310 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8311 backend private_monitoring
8312 stats enable
8313 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8314 stats uri /admin?stats
8315 stats refresh 5s
8316
8317 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8318 global section.
8319
8320
8321stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008322 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8324 yes | yes | yes | yes
8325 Arguments : none
8326
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008327 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008328 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8329 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8330 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8331 - IP (socket, server)
8332 - cookie (backend, server)
8333
8334 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8335 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008336 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008337
8338 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8339
8340
8341stats show-node [ <name> ]
8342 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008344 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008345 Arguments:
8346 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8347 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8348
8349 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8350 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008351 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008352
8353 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8354 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8355 unobvious parameters.
8356
8357 Example:
8358 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8359 backend private_monitoring
8360 stats enable
8361 stats show-node Europe-1
8362 stats uri /admin?stats
8363 stats refresh 5s
8364
8365 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8366 section.
8367
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008368
8369stats uri <prefix>
8370 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008372 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008373 Arguments :
8374 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8375 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8376 query string.
8377
8378 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8379 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8380 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8381 possible to reach it in the application.
8382
8383 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008384 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008385 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8386 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8387 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8388 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8389
8390 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8391 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8392 an address or a port to statistics only.
8393
8394 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8395 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8396 unobvious parameters.
8397
8398 Example :
8399 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8400 backend public_www
8401 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8402 stats enable
8403 stats hide-version
8404 stats scope .
8405 stats uri /admin?stats
8406 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8407 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8408 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8409
8410 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8411 backend private_monitoring
8412 stats enable
8413 stats uri /admin?stats
8414 stats refresh 5s
8415
8416 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8417
8418
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008419stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8420 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008422 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008423
8424 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008425 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008426 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8427 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8428 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8429
8430 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8431 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8432 the "stick-table" statement.
8433
8434 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8435 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8436 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8437 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8438 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8439
8440 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8441 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8442 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8443 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8444 transformation rules.
8445
8446 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8447 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8448 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8449 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8450 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8451 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8452 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8453
8454 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8455 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8456 ACL based conditions.
8457
8458 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8459 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8460 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8461 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8462
8463 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8464 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8465 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8466 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8467
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008468 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8469 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8470 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8471
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008472 Example :
8473 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8474 # last 30 minutes
8475 backend pop
8476 mode tcp
8477 balance roundrobin
8478 stick store-request src
8479 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8480 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8481 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8482
8483 backend smtp
8484 mode tcp
8485 balance roundrobin
8486 stick match src table pop
8487 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8488 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8489
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008490 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008491 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008492
8493
8494stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8495 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8497 no | no | yes | yes
8498
8499 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8500 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8501 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8502 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8503
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008504 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8505 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8506 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8507
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008508 Examples :
8509 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008510 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008511
8512 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8513 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8514 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8515
8516
8517 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8518 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8519 backend http
8520 mode http
8521 balance roundrobin
8522 stick on src table https
8523 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8524 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8525 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8526
8527 backend https
8528 mode tcp
8529 balance roundrobin
8530 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8531 stick on src
8532 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8533 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8534
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008535 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008536
8537
8538stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8539 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8541 no | no | yes | yes
8542
8543 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008544 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008545 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8546 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8547 server is selected.
8548
8549 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8550 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8551 the "stick-table" statement.
8552
8553 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8554 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8555 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8556 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8557 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8558 address.
8559
8560 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8561 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8562 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8563 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8564 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8565 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8566 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8567 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8568 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8569 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8570
8571 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8572 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8573 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8574 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8575 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8576 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8577 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8578
8579 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8580 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8581 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8582 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8583
8584 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8585 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8586 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8587 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8588 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8589 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008590 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8591 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8592 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8593 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8594 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8595 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008596
8597 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8598 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8599 the request.
8600
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008601 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8602 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8603 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8604
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008605 Example :
8606 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8607 # last 30 minutes
8608 backend pop
8609 mode tcp
8610 balance roundrobin
8611 stick store-request src
8612 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8613 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8614 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8615
8616 backend smtp
8617 mode tcp
8618 balance roundrobin
8619 stick match src table pop
8620 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8621 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8622
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008623 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008624 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008625
8626
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008627stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008628 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8629 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008630 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008632 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008633
8634 Arguments :
8635 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8636 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8637 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8638 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8639
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008640 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8641 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8642 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8643 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8644
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008645 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8646 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8647 instance.
8648
8649 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8650 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8651 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8652 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8653 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8654 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008655 to 32 characters.
8656
8657 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8658 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8659 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008660 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008661 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8662 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008663
8664 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008665 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8666 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008667 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8668 increase.
8669
8670 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008671 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8672 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8673 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008674
8675 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8676 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8677 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8678 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8679 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8680 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8681 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8682 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8683 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8684 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8685 parameter (see below).
8686
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008687 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8688 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8689 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8690 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8691 soft restart.
8692
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008693 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8694 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008695
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008696 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8697 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8698 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8699 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008700 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008701 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008702 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8703 if not expiration delay is specified.
8704
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008705 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8706 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8707 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8708 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008709 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8710 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8711 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8712 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8713 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8714 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8715 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8716 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8717 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8718 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8719 types and their arguments.
8720
8721 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8722 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8723 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8724 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8725
8726 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8727 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8728 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8729 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8730
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008731 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8732 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8733 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8734 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8735 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8736 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8737
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008738 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8739 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8740 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8741 they were received.
8742
8743 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8744 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8745 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8746 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8747 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8748
8749 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8750 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8751 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8752 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8753 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8754
8755 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8756 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8757 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8758
8759 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8760 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8761 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8762 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8763 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8764
8765 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8766 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8767 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8768 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8769 the client side.
8770
8771 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8772 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8773 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8774 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8775 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8776 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8777 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8778
8779 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8780 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8781 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8782 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8783 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8784 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8785 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8786
8787 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8788 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8789 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8790 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8791 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8792 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8793
8794 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8795 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8796 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8797 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8798
8799 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8800 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8801 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8802 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8803 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8804 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8805 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8806 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8807 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8808 recommended for better fairness.
8809
8810 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8811 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8812 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8813 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8814
8815 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8816 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8817 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8818 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8819 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8820 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8821 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8822 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8823 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8824 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008825
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008826 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8827 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008828 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8829 reference it.
8830
8831 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8832 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008833 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8834 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8835 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008836
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008837 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8838 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8839 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8840 something that can be ignored.
8841
8842 Example:
8843 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8844 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8845 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8846 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8847
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008848 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008849 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008850
8851
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008852stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008853 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8855 no | no | yes | yes
8856
8857 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008858 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008859 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8860 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8861 server is selected.
8862
8863 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8864 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8865 the "stick-table" statement.
8866
8867 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8868 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8869 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8870 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8871
8872 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8873 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8874 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8875 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8876 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8877 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008878 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008879 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8880 rules.
8881
8882 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8883 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8884 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8885 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8886 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8887 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8888 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8889
8890 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8891 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8892 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8893 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8894
8895 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8896 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8897 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8898 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8899 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8900 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008901 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8902 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8903 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8904 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8905 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8906 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8907 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8908 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8909 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008910
8911 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8912
8913 Example :
8914 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8915 backend https
8916 mode tcp
8917 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008918 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008919 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008920
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008921 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8922 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8923
8924 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8925 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8926 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8927
8928 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8929 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008930
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008931 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8932 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8933 # at offset 44.
8934
8935 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8936 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8937
8938 # Learn on response if server hello.
8939 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008940
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008941 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8942 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8943
8944 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8945 extraction.
8946
8947
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008948tcp-check connect [params*]
8949 Opens a new connection
8950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8951 no | no | yes | yes
8952
8953 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8954 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8955 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8956
8957 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8958 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8959 of the sequence.
8960
8961 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8962 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8963 do.
8964
8965 Parameters :
8966 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8967 use the TCP connection.
8968
8969 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8970 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8971 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8972
8973 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8974
8975 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8976
8977 Examples:
8978 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8979 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8980 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8981 option tcp-check
8982 tcp-check connect
8983 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8984 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8985 tcp-check send \r\n
8986 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8987 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8988 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8989 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8990 tcp-check send \r\n
8991 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8992 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8993
8994 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8995 option tcp-check
8996 tcp-check connect port 110
8997 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8998 tcp-check connect port 143
8999 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9000 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9001
9002 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9003
9004
9005tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
9006 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
9007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9008 no | no | yes | yes
9009
9010 Arguments :
9011 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9012 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9013 binary.
9014 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9015 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9016 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9017
9018 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9019 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9020 with the usual backslash ('\').
9021 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
9022 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
9023 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9024 used upper or lower case.
9025
9026
9027 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9028
9029 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9030 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9031 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9032 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9033 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9034 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9035 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9036 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9037
9038 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9039 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9040 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9041 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9042 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9043 expression.
9044
9045 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9046 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9047 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9048 this exact hexadecimal string.
9049 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9050
9051 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9052 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9053 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9054 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9055 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9056 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9057 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9058 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9059 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9060 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9061 the null character.
9062
9063 Examples :
9064 # perform a POP check
9065 option tcp-check
9066 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9067
9068 # perform an IMAP check
9069 option tcp-check
9070 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9071
9072 # look for the redis master server
9073 option tcp-check
9074 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009075 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009076 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9077 tcp-check expect string role:master
9078 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9079 tcp-check expect string +OK
9080
9081
9082 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9083 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9084
9085
9086tcp-check send <data>
9087 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9088 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9089 no | no | yes | yes
9090
9091 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9092 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9093
9094 Examples :
9095 # look for the redis master server
9096 option tcp-check
9097 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9098 tcp-check expect string role:master
9099
9100 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9101 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9102
9103
9104tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
9105 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
9106 tcp health check
9107 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9108 no | no | yes | yes
9109
9110 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9111 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9112 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
9113 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9114 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9115 hexadecimal string.
9116 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9117
9118 Examples :
9119 # redis check in binary
9120 option tcp-check
9121 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9122 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9123
9124
9125 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9126 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9127
9128
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009129tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9130 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9132 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009133 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009134 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9135 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009136
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009137 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009138
9139 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9140 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009141 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9142 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9143 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9144 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9145 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9146 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009147
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009148 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9149 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9150 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9151 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009152
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009153 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009154 - accept :
9155 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9156 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9157 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009158
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009159 - reject :
9160 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9161 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9162 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9163 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9164 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9165 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9166 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9167 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9168 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9169 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9170 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009171 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009172
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009173 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9174 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9175 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9176 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9177 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9178 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9179 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9180 hosts.
9181
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009182 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9183 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9184 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9185 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9186 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9187 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9188 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9189 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9190
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009191 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9192 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9193 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9194 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9195 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9196 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9197 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9198 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9199 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009200 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9201 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009202
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009203 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009204 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009205 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009206 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009207 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9208 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009209 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009210 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9211 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9212 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9213 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9214 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009216 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009217 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009218 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009219 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9220 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9221 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9222 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009223
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009224 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9225 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9226 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9227 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009228
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009229 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9230 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9231 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9232 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9233 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009234 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9235 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9236 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9237 layer7 information is extracted.
9238
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009239 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9240 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9241 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9242 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9243 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009244
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009245 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9246 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9247 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9248 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9249
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009250 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9251 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9252 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9253 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9254 continues.
9255
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009256 - set-src <expr> :
9257 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9258 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9259 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9260 set-src"
9261
9262 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9263 followed by some converters.
9264
9265 Example:
9266
9267 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9268
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009269 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9270 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009271
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009272 - set-src-port <expr> :
9273 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9274 expression.
9275
9276 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9277 followed by some converters.
9278
9279 Example:
9280
9281 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9282
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009283 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9284 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9285 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009286
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009287 - set-dst <expr> :
9288 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9289 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9290 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9291 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9292 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9293
9294 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9295 followed by some converters.
9296
9297 Example:
9298
9299 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9300 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9301
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009302 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9303 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9304
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009305 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9306 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9307 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9308 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9309
9310
9311 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9312 followed by some converters.
9313
9314 Example:
9315
9316 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9317
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009318 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9319 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9320 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9321
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009322 - "silent-drop" :
9323 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9324 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9325 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9326 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9327 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9328 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9329 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9330 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9331 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9332 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9333 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9334 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9335 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9336 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9337 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9338 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9339
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009340 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9341 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9342 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009343
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009344 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9345 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9346 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009347
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009348 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009349 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009350 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009351
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009352 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9353 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9354 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009355
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009356 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009357 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9358 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009359
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009360 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9361
9362 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9363
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009364 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9365
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009366 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009367
9368
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009369tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9370 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009372 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009373 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009374 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9375 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009376
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009377 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009378
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009379 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9380 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9381 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9382 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9383 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009385 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9386 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9387 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9388 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009389 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9390 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9391 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9392 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9393 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9394 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009395 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009396 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009397
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009398 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9399 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9400 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9401 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009402
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009403 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009404 - accept : the request is accepted
9405 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9406 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009407 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009408 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009409 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009410 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009411 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009412 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009413 - send-spoe-group <engin-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009414
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009415 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9416 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009417
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009418 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9419 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9420 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9421 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9422 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9423 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009425 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009426 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9427 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009428
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009429 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009430 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9431 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9432 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9433 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009434 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9435 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9436 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009437
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009438 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009439 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9440 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9441 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009442
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009443 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009444 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9445 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009446
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009447 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9448 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009449 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009450 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9451 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009452 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009453 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009454 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009455 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9456 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009457 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009458 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9459 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009460
9461 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9462 followed by some converters.
9463
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009464 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9465 <var-name>.
9466
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009467 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9468 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9469 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9470 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9471 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9472
9473 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9474
9475 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9476
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009477 Example:
9478
9479 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009480 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009481
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009482 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009483 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9484 # and reject everything else.
9485 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9486 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009487 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009488 tcp-request content reject
9489
9490 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009491 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9492 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9493 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009494 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009495
9496 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9497 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9498 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009499 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009500 tcp-request content reject
9501
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009502 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009503 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009504 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009505 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009506 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9507 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009508
9509 Example:
9510 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9511 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009512 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009513
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009514 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009515 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009516
9517 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009518 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009519 # protecting all our sites
9520 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009521 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9522 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009523 ...
9524 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9525
9526 backend http_dynamic
9527 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009528 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009529 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009530 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009531 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009532 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009533 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009534
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009535 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009536
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009537 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9538 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009539
9540
9541tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9542 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009544 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009545 Arguments :
9546 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9547 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9548 as explained at the top of this document.
9549
9550 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9551 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9552 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9553 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9554 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9555
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009556 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9557 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9558 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9559 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9560
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009561 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9562 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009563 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009564 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009565 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9566 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9567 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9568 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009569
9570 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9571 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9572 it pass through unaffected.
9573
9574 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9575 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9576 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009577 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009578 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9579 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009580 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9581 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9582 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009583
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009584 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009585 "timeout client".
9586
9587
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009588tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9589 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9591 no | no | yes | yes
9592 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009593 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9594 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009595
9596 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9597
9598 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9599 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9600 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009601 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9602 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009603
9604 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9605
9606 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9607 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9608 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9609 inserted.
9610
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009611 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009612 - accept :
9613 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9614 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9615 the rules evaluation.
9616
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009617 - close :
9618 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9619 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9620 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9621 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9622 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9623 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009624 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009625 protocols.
9626
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009627 - reject :
9628 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9629 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009630 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009631
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009632 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9633 Sets a variable.
9634
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009635 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9636 Unsets a variable.
9637
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009638 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9639 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9640 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9641 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9642
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009643 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9644 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9645 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9646 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9647 continues.
9648
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009649 - "silent-drop" :
9650 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9651 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9652 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9653 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9654 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9655 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9656 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9657 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9658 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9659 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9660 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9661 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9662 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9663 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9664 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9665 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9666
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009667 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9668 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9669
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009670 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9671 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9672 for changing the default action to a reject.
9673
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009674 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9675 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9676 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9677 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009678 period.
9679
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009680 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9681 declared inline.
9682
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009683 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9684 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009685 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009686 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9687 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009688 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009689 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009690 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009691 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9692 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009693 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009694 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9695 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009696
9697 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9698 followed by some converters.
9699
9700 Example:
9701
9702 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9703
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009704 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9705 <var-name>.
9706
9707 Example:
9708
9709 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9710
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009711 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9712 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9713 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9714 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9715 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9716
9717 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9718
9719 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9720
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009721 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9722
9723 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9724
9725
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009726tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9727 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9729 no | yes | yes | no
9730 Arguments :
9731 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9732 below.
9733
9734 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9735
9736 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9737 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9738 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9739 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9740 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9741 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9742 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9743 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9744 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9745 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9746 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9747 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9748 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9749 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9750 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9751 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9752 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9753 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9754 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9755 instead.
9756
9757 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9758 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9759 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9760 rules which may be inserted.
9761
9762 Several types of actions are supported :
9763 - accept : the request is accepted
9764 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9765 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9766 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9767 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9768 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009769 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009770 - silent-drop
9771
9772 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9773 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9774 sections for a complete description.
9775
9776 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9777 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9778 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9779
9780 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9781 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9782 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9783 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9784 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9785
9786 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9787 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9788
9789 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9790 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9791 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9792
9793 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9794 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9795 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9796
9797 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9798 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9799 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9800
9801 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9802 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9803 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9804
9805 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9806
9807 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9808
9809
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009810tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9811 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9813 no | no | yes | yes
9814 Arguments :
9815 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9816 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9817 as explained at the top of this document.
9818
9819 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9820
9821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009822timeout check <timeout>
9823 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9824 established.
9825
9826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9827 yes | no | yes | yes
9828 Arguments:
9829 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9830 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9831 as explained at the top of this document.
9832
9833 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9834 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9835 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9836 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009837 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9838 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9839 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009840
9841 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9842 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9843
9844 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9845 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009846 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009847
9848 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9849 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9850 forget about it.
9851
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009852 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9853 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009854
9855
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009856timeout client <timeout>
9857timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9858 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9860 yes | yes | yes | no
9861 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009862 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009863 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9864 as explained at the top of this document.
9865
9866 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9867 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9868 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009869 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9870 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9871 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9872 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009873 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9874 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9875 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009876 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009877 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009878 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9879 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009880 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9881 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009882
9883 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9884 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9885 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9886 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9887 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9888 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9889
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +01009890 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +01009891
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009892 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9893 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9894 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9895
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009896 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9897 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009898
9899
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009900timeout client-fin <timeout>
9901 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9903 yes | yes | yes | no
9904 Arguments :
9905 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9906 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9907 as explained at the top of this document.
9908
9909 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9910 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9911 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9912 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9913 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9914 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9915 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +01009916 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
9917 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
9918 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009919
9920 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9921 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9922 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9923
9924 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9925
9926
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009927timeout connect <timeout>
9928timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9929 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9931 yes | no | yes | yes
9932 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009933 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009934 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9935 as explained at the top of this document.
9936
9937 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009938 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009939 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009940 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009941 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9942 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009943
9944 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9945 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9946 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9947 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9948 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9949 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9950
9951 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9952 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9953 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9954
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009955 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9956 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009957
9958
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009959timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9960 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9962 yes | yes | yes | yes
9963 Arguments :
9964 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9965 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9966 as explained at the top of this document.
9967
9968 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9969 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9970 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9971 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9972 once the request has started to present itself.
9973
9974 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9975 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9976 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9977 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9978 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9979
9980 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9981 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9982 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9983 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9984
9985 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9986 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9987 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9988 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9989 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009990 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009991
9992 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9993 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9994 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9995 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9996
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +01009997 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
9998 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +01009999 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10000
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010001 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10002
10003
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010004timeout http-request <timeout>
10005 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010007 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010008 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010009 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010010 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10011 as explained at the top of this document.
10012
10013 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10014 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10015 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10016 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10017 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10018 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10019 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010020 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10021 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10022 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10023 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
10024 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010025 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10026 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010027
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010028 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10029 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10030 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10031 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10032 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010033 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010034
10035 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10036 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
10037 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
10038 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10039 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10040
10041 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010042 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10043 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10044 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010045
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010046 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010047 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010048
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010049
10050timeout queue <timeout>
10051 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10053 yes | no | yes | yes
10054 Arguments :
10055 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10056 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10057 as explained at the top of this document.
10058
10059 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10060 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10061 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10062 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10063 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10064
10065 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10066 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10067 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10068 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10069
10070 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10071
10072
10073timeout server <timeout>
10074timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10075 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10077 yes | no | yes | yes
10078 Arguments :
10079 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10080 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10081 as explained at the top of this document.
10082
10083 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10084 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10085 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10086 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10087 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10088 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10089 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10090
10091 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10092 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10093 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10094 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10095 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010096 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010097 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010098 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10099 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
10100 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10101 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010102
10103 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10104 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10105 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10106 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10107 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10108 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10109
10110 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10111 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10112 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10113
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010114 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010115
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010116
10117timeout server-fin <timeout>
10118 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10120 yes | no | yes | yes
10121 Arguments :
10122 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10123 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10124 as explained at the top of this document.
10125
10126 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10127 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10128 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10129 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10130 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10131 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10132 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10133 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10134 situations, it should not be needed.
10135
10136 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10137 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10138 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10139
10140 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10141
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010142
10143timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010144 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10146 yes | yes | yes | yes
10147 Arguments :
10148 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10150 as explained at the top of this document.
10151
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010152 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10153 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10154 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10155 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010156
10157 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10158 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10159 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10160 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010161 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010162
10163 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10164
10165
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010166timeout tunnel <timeout>
10167 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10169 yes | no | yes | yes
10170 Arguments :
10171 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10172 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10173 as explained at the top of this document.
10174
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010175 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010176 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10177 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10178 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
10179 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
10180 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
10181 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10182 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10183 specified.
10184
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010185 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10186 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10187 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10188 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10189 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10190 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10191 state.
10192
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010193 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10194 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10195 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10196 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
10197 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
10198
10199 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10200 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10201 forget about it.
10202
10203 Example :
10204 defaults http
10205 option http-server-close
10206 timeout connect 5s
10207 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010208 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010209 timeout server 30s
10210 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10211
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010212 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010213
10214
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010215transparent (deprecated)
10216 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010218 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010219 Arguments : none
10220
10221 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10222 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10223 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10224 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10225 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10226 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10227 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10228 appropriate server.
10229
10230 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10231
10232 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10233 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10234
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010235 See also: "option transparent"
10236
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010237unique-id-format <string>
10238 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10240 yes | yes | yes | no
10241 Arguments :
10242 <string> is a log-format string.
10243
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010244 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10245 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10246 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10247 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010248
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010249 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10250 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10251 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10252 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10253 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10254 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10255 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10256 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010257
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010258 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10259 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010260
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010261 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010262
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010263 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010264
10265 will generate:
10266
10267 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10268
10269 See also: "unique-id-header"
10270
10271unique-id-header <name>
10272 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10274 yes | yes | yes | no
10275 Arguments :
10276 <name> is the name of the header.
10277
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010278 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10279 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010280
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010281 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010282
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010283 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010284 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10285
10286 will generate:
10287
10288 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10289
10290 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010291
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010292use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010293 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10295 no | yes | yes | no
10296 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010297 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10298 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010299
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010300 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10301 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010302
10303 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10304 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10305 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010306 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10307 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10308 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10309 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010310
10311 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10312 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10313 assign the backend.
10314
10315 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10316 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10317 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10318 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10319 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10320 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10321
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010322 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010323 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010324 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10325 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10326 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10327
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010328 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10329 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10330 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10331 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10332 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10333 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10334 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10335 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10336 cannot be forced from the request.
10337
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010338 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010339 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10340 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10341
10342 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10343 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010344
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010345
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010346use-server <server> if <condition>
10347use-server <server> unless <condition>
10348 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10350 no | no | yes | yes
10351 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010352 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010353
10354 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10355
10356 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10357 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10358 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10359
10360 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10361 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10362 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10363 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10364 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10365 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10366 matches will assign the server.
10367
10368 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10369 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10370 with the next rules until one matches.
10371
10372 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10373 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10374 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10375 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10376
10377 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10378 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10379 stripped.
10380
10381 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10382 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10383 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10384 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10385
10386 Example :
10387 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10388 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10389 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10390 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10391 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10392 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010393 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010394 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10395 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10396
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010397 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010398
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010399
104005. Bind and Server options
10401--------------------------
10402
10403The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10404depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10405settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10406written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10407described in this section.
10408
10409
104105.1. Bind options
10411-----------------
10412
10413The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10414as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10415no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10416parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10417while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10418provided immediately after the setting name.
10419
10420The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10421
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010422accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10423 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10424 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10425 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10426 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10427 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10428 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10429 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10430 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10431 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010432 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10433 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10434 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010435
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010436accept-proxy
10437 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010438 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10439 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010440 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10441 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10442 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10443 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10444 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10445 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10446 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010447 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10448 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010449
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010450allow-0rtt
10451 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10452 due to security considerations.
10453
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010454alpn <protocols>
10455 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10456 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10457 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10458 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10459 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010460 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10461 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10462 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10463 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10464 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10465 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10466 preference, like below :
10467
10468 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010469
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010470backlog <backlog>
10471 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10472 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10473
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010474curves <curves>
10475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10476 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10477 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10478 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10479 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10480 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10481
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010482ecdhe <named curve>
10483 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010484 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10485 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010486
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010487ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10489 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10490 client's certificate.
10491
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010492ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10493 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10494 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10495 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10496 error is ignored.
10497
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010498ca-sign-file <cafile>
10499 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10500 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10501 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10502 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10503 'generate-certificates' for details.
10504
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010505ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10507 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10508 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10509 'generate-certificates' for details.
10510
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010511ciphers <ciphers>
10512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10513 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010514 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010515 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10516 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010517 Depending on the compatiblity and security requirements, the list of suitable
10518 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10519 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10520 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010521
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010522crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010523 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10524 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10525 to verify client's certificate.
10526
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010527crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010528 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10529 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10530 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10531 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10532 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10533 file.
10534
10535 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10536 are loaded.
10537
10538 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010539 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010540 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10541 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10542 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10543 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10544 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10545 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10546 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010547
10548 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10549 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10550 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10551 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010552 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10553 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010554
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010555 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010556
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010557 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10558 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010559 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010560 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10561 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10562 clients).
10563
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010564 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10565 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10566 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10567 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10568 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10569 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10570 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10571 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10572 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10573 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10574 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10575 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10576 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10577
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010578 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10579 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10580 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10581 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10582 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10583
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010584 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10585 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10586 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10587 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010588
10589 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10590 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10591 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10592 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10593 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10594 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10595 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10596 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10597 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10598
10599 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10600
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010601 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010602 a cert bundle.
10603
10604 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10605 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10606 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10607 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10608 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10609 provide multi-cert support.
10610
10611 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10612
10613 Filename | CN | SAN
10614 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10615 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010616 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010617 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10618 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10619
10620 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10621 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10622 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10623 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010624 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10625 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10626 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010627
10628 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10629 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10630
10631 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10632 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10633 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10634
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010635crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010636 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10637 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010638 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010639 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010640
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010641crt-list <file>
10642 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010643 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10644 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010645
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010646 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10647
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010648 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10649 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010650 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010651 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010652
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010653 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10654 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10655 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10656 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10657 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10658 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10659 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10660 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010661
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010662 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010663 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010664 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10665 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10666 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010667
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010668 crt-list file example:
10669 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010670 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010671 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010672 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010673
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010674defer-accept
10675 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10676 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10677 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10678 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10679 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10680 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10681 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10682 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10683 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10684 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10685 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10686
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010687expose-fd listeners
10688 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10689 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010690 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10691 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010692 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10693
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010694force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010695 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010696 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010697 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010698 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010699
10700force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010701 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010702 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010703 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010704
10705force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010706 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010707 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010708 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010709
10710force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010711 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010712 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010713 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010714
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010715force-tlsv13
10716 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10717 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010718 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010719
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010720generate-certificates
10721 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10722 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10723 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10724 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10725 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10726 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10727 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10728 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10729 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10730 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10731 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10732
10733 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10734 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10735 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10736 certificate is used many times.
10737
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010738gid <gid>
10739 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10740 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10741 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10742 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10743 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10744
10745group <group>
10746 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10747 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10748 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10749 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10750 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10751
10752id <id>
10753 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10754 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10755 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10756 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10757
10758interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010759 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10760 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10761 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10762 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10763 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10764 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10765 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010766
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010767level <level>
10768 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10769 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10770 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10771 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10772 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10773 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10774 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10775 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10776 counters).
10777 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10778 all counters).
10779
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010780severity-output <format>
10781 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10782 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10783 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10784 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10785 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10786 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10787 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10788 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10789 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10790 rfc5424 convention.
10791
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010792maxconn <maxconn>
10793 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10794 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10795 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10796 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10797 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10798 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10799 eat all memory.
10800
10801mode <mode>
10802 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10803 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10804 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10805 UNIX sockets.
10806
10807mss <maxseg>
10808 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10809 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10810 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10811 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10812 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10813 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10814 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10815 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10816 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10817 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10818 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10819
10820name <name>
10821 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10822 page.
10823
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010824namespace <name>
10825 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10826 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10827 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10828 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10829
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010830nice <nice>
10831 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10832 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10833 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10834 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10835 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10836 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10837 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10838 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10839 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10840 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10841 one for an RDP socket.
10842
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010843no-ca-names
10844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10845 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10846
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010847no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010849 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010850 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010851 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010852 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10853 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010854
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010855no-tls-tickets
10856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10857 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10858 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010859 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10860 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010861
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010862no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010863 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010864 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010865 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010866 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010867 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10868 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010869
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010870no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010872 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010873 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010874 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010875 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10876 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010877
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010878no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010879 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010880 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010881 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010882 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010883 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10884 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010885
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010886no-tlsv13
10887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10888 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10889 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10890 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010891 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10892 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010893
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010894npn <protocols>
10895 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10896 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10897 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10898 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010899 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010900 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
10901 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
10902 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
10903 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
10904 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010905
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010906prefer-client-ciphers
10907 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10908 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10909 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10910
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010911process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
10912 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
10913 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
10914 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
10915 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
10916 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
10917 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
10918 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
10919 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process inoming
10920 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
10921 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
10922 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
10923
10924 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
10925
10926 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
10927 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
10928 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
10929 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
10930 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
10931 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
10932 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
10933 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010934
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010935ssl
10936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010937 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010938 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10939 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010940 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10941 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010942
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010943ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10944 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10945 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10946 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10947
10948ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10949 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10950 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10951 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10952
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010953strict-sni
10954 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10955 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10956 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10957 See the "crt" option for more information.
10958
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010959tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010960 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010961 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10962 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010963 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010964 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10965 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10966 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10967 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10968 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10969 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10970 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10971
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010972tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010973 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010974 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10975 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10976 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10977 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10978 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10979 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10980 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010981 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10982 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10983 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010984
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010985tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10986 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10987 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10988 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10989 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10990 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10991 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10992 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10993 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10994 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10995 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10996
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010997transparent
10998 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10999 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11000 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11001 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11002 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11003 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11004 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11005 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11006 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11007 so check for support with your vendor.
11008
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011009v4v6
11010 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11011 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11012 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11013 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011014 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011015
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011016v6only
11017 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11018 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11019 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011020 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11021 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011022
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011023uid <uid>
11024 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11025 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11026 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11027 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11028 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11029
11030user <user>
11031 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11032 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11033 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11034 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11035 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11036
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011037verify [none|optional|required]
11038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11039 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11040 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11041 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11042 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011043 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11044 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11045 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11046 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011047
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200110485.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011049------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011051The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11052which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11053arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11054settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11055after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11056Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11057address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011059 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011060 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011061
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011062Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11063keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011065The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011066
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011067addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011068 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011069 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11070 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11071 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11072 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11073 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011074
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011075agent-check
11076 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011077 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
11078 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
11079 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
11080 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011081
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011082 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011083 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011084 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11085 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11086 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011087
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011088 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
11089 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11090 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
11091 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
11092 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
11093
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011094 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11095 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011096
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011097 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11098 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11099 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011100
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011101 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11102 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11103 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011104
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011105 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11106 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11107 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11108 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11109 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
11110 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
11111 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011112
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011113 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11114 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011115
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011116 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11117 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11118 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11119 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11120 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11121 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11122 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11123 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11124 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011125
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011126 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11127 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011128 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11129 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11130 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011131 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011132
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011133 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011134 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011135
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011136agent-send <string>
11137 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11138 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11139 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11140 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11141 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11142
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011143agent-inter <delay>
11144 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11145 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11146
11147 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11148 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11149 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11150 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11151 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11152 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11153 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11154 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11155 of backends use the same servers.
11156
11157 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11158
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011159agent-addr <addr>
11160 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11161
11162 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11163 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11164 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11165 hostname, it will be resolved.
11166
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011167agent-port <port>
11168 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11169
11170 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011172backup
11173 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11174 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11175 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11176 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011177 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11178 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011179
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011180ca-file <cafile>
11181 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11182 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11183 server's certificate.
11184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011185check
11186 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011187 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11188 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11189 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11190 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11191 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11192 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11193 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011194 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11195 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011196 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11197 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011198
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011199check-send-proxy
11200 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11201 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11202 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11203 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11204 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11205 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11206 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11207
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011208check-sni
11209 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11210 over SSL.
11211
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011212check-ssl
11213 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11214 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11215 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11216 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011217 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011218 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11219 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
11220 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011221 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11222 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011223
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011224ciphers <ciphers>
11225 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011226 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011227 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11228 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11229 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11230 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11231 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11232 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011234cookie <value>
11235 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11236 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11237 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11238 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11239 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11240 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11241 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11242
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011243crl-file <crlfile>
11244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11245 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11246 to verify server's certificate.
11247
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011248crt <cert>
11249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11250 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11251 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11252 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11253 certificate request.
11254
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011255disabled
11256 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11257 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11258 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11259 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11260 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011261 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011262
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011263enabled
11264 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11265 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11266 default value.
11267 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11268 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011269
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011270error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011271 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11272 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11273 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011274
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011275 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011277fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011278 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11279 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11280 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11281
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011282force-sslv3
11283 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11284 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011285 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011286 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011287
11288force-tlsv10
11289 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011290 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011291 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011292
11293force-tlsv11
11294 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011295 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011296 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011297
11298force-tlsv12
11299 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011300 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011301 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011302
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011303force-tlsv13
11304 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11305 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011306 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011308id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011309 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11310 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11311 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011312
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011313init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11314 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11315 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11316 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11317 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11318 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11319 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11320 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11321 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11322 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11323 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11324 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11325 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11326 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11327 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11328 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11329 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11330 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11331 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11332 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11333 historic behaviour.
11334
11335 Example:
11336 defaults
11337 # never fail on address resolution
11338 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011340inter <delay>
11341fastinter <delay>
11342downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011343 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11344 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11345 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11346 between checks depending on the server state :
11347
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011348 Server state | Interval used
11349 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11350 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11351 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11352 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11353 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11354 or yet unchecked. |
11355 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11356 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11357 | "inter" otherwise.
11358 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011360 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11361 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11362 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11363 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011364 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11365 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11366 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11367 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11368 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011370maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011371 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11372 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11373 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11374 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11375 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11376 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11377 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11378 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011380maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011381 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11382 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11383 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11384 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11385 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11386 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11387 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11388
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011389minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011390 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11391 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11392 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11393 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11394 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11395 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011396 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011397 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011398
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011399namespace <name>
11400 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11401 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11402 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11403 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11404
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011405no-agent-check
11406 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11407 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11408 default value.
11409 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11410 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11411
11412no-backup
11413 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11414 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11415 default value.
11416 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11417 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11418
11419no-check
11420 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11421 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11422 default value.
11423 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11424 "default-server" "check" setting.
11425
11426no-check-ssl
11427 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11428 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11429 default value.
11430 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11431 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11432
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011433no-send-proxy
11434 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11435 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11436 default value.
11437 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11438 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11439
11440no-send-proxy-v2
11441 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11442 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11443 default value.
11444 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11445 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11446
11447no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11448 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11449 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11450 default value.
11451 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11452 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11453
11454no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11455 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11456 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11457 default value.
11458 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11459 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11460
11461no-ssl
11462 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11463 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11464 default value.
11465 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11466 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11467
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011468no-ssl-reuse
11469 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11470 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11471 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11472 and for paranoid users.
11473
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011474no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011475 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11476 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011477 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011478
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011479 Supported in default-server: No
11480
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011481no-tls-tickets
11482 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11483 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11484 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011485 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11486 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011487 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011488
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011489no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011490 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011491 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11492 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011493 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11494 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011495 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011496
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011497 Supported in default-server: No
11498
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011499no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011500 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011501 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11502 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011503 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11504 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011505 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011506
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011507 Supported in default-server: No
11508
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011509no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011510 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011511 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11512 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011513 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11514 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011515 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011516
11517 Supported in default-server: No
11518
11519no-tlsv13
11520 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11521 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11522 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11523 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11524 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011525 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011526
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011527 Supported in default-server: No
11528
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011529no-verifyhost
11530 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11531 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11532 default value.
11533 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11534 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011535
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011536non-stick
11537 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11538 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11539 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11540
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011541observe <mode>
11542 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11543 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11544 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11545 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11546 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11547 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011548 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011549
11550 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11551
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011552on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011553 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11554 Currently, four modes are available:
11555 - fastinter: force fastinter
11556 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11557 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11558 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11559 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11560
11561 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11562
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011563on-marked-down <action>
11564 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11565 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011566 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11567 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11568 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11569 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11570 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11571 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11572 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11573 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011574
11575 Actions are disabled by default
11576
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011577on-marked-up <action>
11578 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11579 Currently one action is available:
11580 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11581 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11582 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11583 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11584 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11585 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11586 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11587 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11588
11589 Actions are disabled by default
11590
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011591port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011592 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11593 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11594 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11595 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11596 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11597 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11598
11599redir <prefix>
11600 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11601 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11602 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11603 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11604 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11605 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11606 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11607 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011608 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011609 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11610 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11611 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11612 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11613 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11614
11615 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011617rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011618 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11619 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11620 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11621
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011622resolve-prefer <family>
11623 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11624 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11625 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11626 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11627
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011628 Default value: ipv6
11629
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011630 Example:
11631
11632 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011633
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011634resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11635 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11636 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011637 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011638 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11639 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11640 configured network, another address is selected.
11641
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011642 Example:
11643
11644 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011645
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011646resolvers <id>
11647 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11648 hostname.
11649
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011650 Example:
11651
11652 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011653
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011654 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011655
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011656send-proxy
11657 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11658 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11659 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11660 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011661 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11662 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11663 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11664 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11665 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11666 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11667 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11668 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11669 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11670 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011671 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11672 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011673
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011674send-proxy-v2
11675 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11676 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11677 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11678 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011679 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11680 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11681 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11682 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011683
11684send-proxy-v2-ssl
11685 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11686 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11687 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11688 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11689 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11690 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11691 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011692 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11693 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011694
11695send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11696 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11697 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11698 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11699 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11700 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11701 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11702 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11703 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011704 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11705 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011707slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011708 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11709 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11710 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11711 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11712 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11713 parameters :
11714
11715 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11716 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11717
11718 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11719 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11720 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11721 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11722
11723 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11724 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11725 seen as failed.
11726
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011727sni <expression>
11728 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11729 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11730 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11731 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011732 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11733 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011734 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11735 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011736
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011737source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011738source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011739source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011740 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11741 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11742 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11743 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11744
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011745 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11746 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11747 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11748 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11749 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11750 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11751 server.
11752
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011753 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11754 specifying the source address without port(s).
11755
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011756ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011757 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11758 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11759 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11760 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11761 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11762 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011763 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11764 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011765
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011766ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11767 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11768 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11769 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11770
11771ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11772 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11773 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11774 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11775
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011776ssl-reuse
11777 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11778 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11779 default value.
11780 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11781 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11782
11783stick
11784 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11785 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11786 default value.
11787 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11788 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011789
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011790tcp-ut <delay>
11791 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11792 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11793 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011794 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011795 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11796 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11797 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11798 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11799 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11800 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11801 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11802 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11803 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011805track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011806 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11807 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11808 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11809 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011810 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11811
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011812tls-tickets
11813 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11814 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11815 default value.
11816 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11817 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011818
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011819verify [none|required]
11820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011821 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011822 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11823 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
11824 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributs match either
11825 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11826 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11827 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11828 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11829 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11830 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11831 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11832 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011833
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011834verifyhost <hostname>
11835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011836 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11837 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11838 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11839 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11840 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11841 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11842 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11843 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011845weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011846 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11847 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11848 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011849 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11850 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11851 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11852 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11853 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11854 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011855
11856
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200118575.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11858-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011859
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011860HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11861using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11862configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011863This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11864can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11865workload.
11866This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11867resolution at run time.
11868Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11869carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11870
11871
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200118725.3.1. Global overview
11873----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011874
11875As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11876different steps of the process life:
11877
11878 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11879 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11880 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11881
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011882 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
11883 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011884
11885A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11886 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11887 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11888 resolution to know this new IP.
11889
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011890When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
11891HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
11892SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
11893from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
11894will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
11895will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011896
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011897A few things important to notice:
11898 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11899 first valid response.
11900
11901 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11902 servers return an error.
11903
11904
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200119055.3.2. The resolvers section
11906----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011907
11908This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011909HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
11910contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011911
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011912When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11913uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11914is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11915answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11916
11917When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011918used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011919
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011920 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
11921 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
11922 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011923
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011924 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
11925 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011926
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011927 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
11928 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
11929 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011930
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011931For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
11932following scenarios are possible:
11933
11934 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
11935 ignored
11936
11937 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11938 applied
11939
11940 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11941 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
11942
11943 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
11944 retries the query with a new type
11945
11946 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
11947 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011948
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011949As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
11950a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011951<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011952
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011953
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011954resolvers <resolvers id>
11955 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11956
11957A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11958
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011959accepted_payload_size <nb>
11960 Defines the maxium payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011961 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011962 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
11963 by RFC 6891)
11964
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011965 Note: to get bigger responses but still be sure that responses won't be
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011966 dropped on the wire, one can choose a value between 1280 and 1410.
11967
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011968 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
11969
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011970nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11971 DNS server description:
11972 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11973 <ip> : IP address of the server
11974 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11975
11976hold <status> <period>
11977 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11978 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011979 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011980 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011981 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11982 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11983 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11984
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020011985 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011986
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011987resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020011988 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
11989 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
11990 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
11991
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011992resolve_retries <nb>
11993 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11994 giving up.
11995 Default value: 3
11996
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011997 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11998 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11999 type.
12000
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012001timeout <event> <time>
12002 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12003 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12004 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012005 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12006 other time applied.
12007 Default value: 1s
12008 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12009 have been received.
12010 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012011 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12012 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12013
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012014 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012015
12016 resolvers mydns
12017 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12018 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
12019 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012020 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012021 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012022 hold other 30s
12023 hold refused 30s
12024 hold nx 30s
12025 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012026 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012027 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012028
12029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120306. HTTP header manipulation
12031---------------------------
12032
12033In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12034response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12035request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12036which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012037against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012038
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012039If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12040to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12041but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12042HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12043stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12044because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12045a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12046still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012048This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12049in section 4.2 :
12050
12051 - reqadd <string>
12052 - reqallow <search>
12053 - reqiallow <search>
12054 - reqdel <search>
12055 - reqidel <search>
12056 - reqdeny <search>
12057 - reqideny <search>
12058 - reqpass <search>
12059 - reqipass <search>
12060 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12061 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12062 - reqtarpit <search>
12063 - reqitarpit <search>
12064 - rspadd <string>
12065 - rspdel <search>
12066 - rspidel <search>
12067 - rspdeny <search>
12068 - rspideny <search>
12069 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12070 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12071
12072With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12073is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12074parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12075prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12076Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12077
12078 \t for a tab
12079 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12080 \n for a new line (LF)
12081 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12082 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12083 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12084 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12085 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12086
12087The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12088portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12089above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12090regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
120919 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12092is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12093
12094The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12095after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12096
12097Notes related to these keywords :
12098---------------------------------
12099 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12100 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12101 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12102
12103 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12104 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12105 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12106
12107 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12108 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12109 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12110 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12111 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12112
12113 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12114 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12115 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12116 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12117 useless headers before adding new ones.
12118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012119 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012120 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12121
12122 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12123 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12124 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12125
12126 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12127 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012128 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012129
12130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121317. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12132----------------------------------
12133
12134Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
12135client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12136The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12137these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12138but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12139data called patterns.
12140
12141
121427.1. ACL basics
12143---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012144
12145The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12146content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12147from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12148simple :
12149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012150 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012151 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012152 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12153 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012155The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12156adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012157
12158In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012160 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012161
12162This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12163Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12164and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012165an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12166conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12167as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12168are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012169
12170ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12171'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12172which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12173
12174There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12175performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012177The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12178specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12179this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012180methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12181ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012182
12183Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12184 - boolean
12185 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12186 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12187 - string
12188 - data block
12189
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012190Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12191converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12192would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12193The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12194which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12195
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012196Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12197keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12198fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12199which are summarized in the table below :
12200
12201 +---------------------+-----------------+
12202 | Sample or converter | Default |
12203 | output type | matching method |
12204 +---------------------+-----------------+
12205 | boolean | bool |
12206 +---------------------+-----------------+
12207 | integer | int |
12208 +---------------------+-----------------+
12209 | ip | ip |
12210 +---------------------+-----------------+
12211 | string | str |
12212 +---------------------+-----------------+
12213 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12214 +---------------------+-----------------+
12215
12216Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12217matching method, see below.
12218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012219The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12220 - boolean
12221 - integer or integer range
12222 - IP address / network
12223 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12224 - regular expression
12225 - hex block
12226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012227The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12228
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012229 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12230 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012231 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012232 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012233 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012234 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012235 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012237The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12238read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12239if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12240lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12241will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12242beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12243a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12244lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12245exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12246
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012247The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12248parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12249ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12250a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12251check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12252
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012253The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12254socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12255file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012257Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12258loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12259
12260 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12261
12262In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12263the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12264case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12265as well.
12266
12267The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12268sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12269do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12270methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12271is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
12272obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
12273followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12274default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12275that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12276string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12277
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012278The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12279By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12280string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12281resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12282server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12283waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12284flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12285function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012287There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12288sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12289be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012290
12291 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12292 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012293 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12294 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12295 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12296 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012297
12298 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12299 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012300 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012301
12302 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012303 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012304
12305 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012306 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012307
12308 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12309 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12310
12311 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12312 binary or string samples.
12313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012314 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12315 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012317 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12318 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12319 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012321 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12322 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012324 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12325 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012327 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12328 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012330 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12331 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012332 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012334 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12335 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12336 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012337
12338For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12339request, it is possible to do :
12340
12341 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12342
12343In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12344buffer, one would use the following acl :
12345
12346 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12347
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012348On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12349possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12350
12351 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012353All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12354criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12355method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12356to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12357criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12358the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012360If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012361the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12362For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012364 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12365 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12366 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12367 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012368
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012369
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012370The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12371types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12372combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12373brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12374default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012376 +-------------------------------------------------+
12377 | Input sample type |
12378 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012379 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012380 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12381 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12382 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012383 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012384 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012385 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012386 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012387 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012388 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012389 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012390 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012391 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012392 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012393 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012394 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012395 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012396 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012397 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012398 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012399 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012400 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012401 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012402 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012403 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012404 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12405 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12406 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012407
12408
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124097.1.1. Matching booleans
12410------------------------
12411
12412In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12413Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12414When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12415that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12416
12417Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12418return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12419"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12420
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124227.1.2. Matching integers
12423------------------------
12424
12425Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12426enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12427to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12428
12429Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12430matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12431lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012432
12433For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12434unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12435representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12436
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012437As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12438two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12439instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12440ranges and operators.
12441
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012442For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012443operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12444Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12445of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012447Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012448
12449 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12450 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12451 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12452 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12453 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12454
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012455For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012456
12457 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12458
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012459This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12460
12461 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12462
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124647.1.3. Matching strings
12465-----------------------
12466
12467String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12468different forms :
12469
12470 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12471 patterns ;
12472
12473 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12474 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12475
12476 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12477 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12478
12479 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12480 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12481
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012482 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012483 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12484 matches.
12485
12486 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12487 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12488 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012489
12490String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12491exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12492characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12493string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12494to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012495before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012496
12497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124987.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12499---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012500
12501Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12502they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12503possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12504passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12505the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012506the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12507match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012508
12509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200125107.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12511-------------------------------------
12512
12513It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12514not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12515a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12516to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12517digits may be used upper or lower case.
12518
12519Example :
12520 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12521 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12522
12523
125247.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12525---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012526
12527IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12528netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12529within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012530host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012531difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12532at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12533does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12534parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012535
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012536The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12537abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12538
12539 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12540 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12541 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12542 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12543 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12544 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12545 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12546 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12547
12548Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12549192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12550
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012551IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12552Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12553trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12554IPv6 patterns.
12555
12556HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12557following situations :
12558 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12559 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12560 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12561 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12562 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12563 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12564 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12565 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12566 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12567 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012569
125707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12571----------------------------------
12572
12573Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12574combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12575
12576 - AND (implicit)
12577 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12578 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012580A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012582 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012584Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12585indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012587For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12588"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12589requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12590is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12591
12592 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012593 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12594 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12595 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012596
12597To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12598and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12599
12600 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12601 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12602 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12603 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12604
12605 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12606 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12607 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12608 use_backend www if host_www
12609
12610It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12611expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12612be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12613the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12614
12615 The following rule :
12616
12617 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012618 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012619
12620 Can also be written that way :
12621
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012622 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012623
12624It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12625to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12626simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12627sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12628good use is the following :
12629
12630 With named ACLs :
12631
12632 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12633 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12634 monitor fail if site_dead
12635
12636 With anonymous ACLs :
12637
12638 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12639
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012640See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12641keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012642
12643
126447.3. Fetching samples
12645---------------------
12646
12647Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12648against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12649sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12650ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12651of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12652available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12653
12654This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12655Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12656compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12657deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12658
12659The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12660matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12661method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12662indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12663
12664As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12665when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12666mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12667the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12668ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12669
12670Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12671multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12672when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12673incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12674are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12675is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12676all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12677
12678Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12679 - name
12680 - name(arg1)
12681 - name(arg1,arg2)
12682
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012683
126847.3.1. Converters
12685-----------------
12686
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012687Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12688of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12689is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12690was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12691has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12692unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12693
12694These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12695sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12696the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12697support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012698
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012699A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12700support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12701supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12702(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12703bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012705The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012706
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001270751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12708 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12709 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12710 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12711 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12712 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12713
12714 Example :
12715 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12716 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12717 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12718 frontend http-in
12719 bind *:8081
12720 default_backend servers
12721 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12722 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12723
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012724add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012725 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012726 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012727 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12728 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012729 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012730 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12731 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12732 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12733 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12734 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012735 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012736
12737and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012738 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012739 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012740 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12741 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012742 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012743 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12744 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12745 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12746 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12747 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012748 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012749
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012750b64dec
12751 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12752 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12753
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012754base64
12755 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12756 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12757 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12758
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012759bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012760 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012761 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12762 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12763 presence of a flag).
12764
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012765bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12766 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12767 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012768 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012769
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012770cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012771 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12772 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012773
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012774crc32([<avalanche>])
12775 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12776 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12777 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12778 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12779 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12780 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12781 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12782 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12783 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12784 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12785 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12786
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012787da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012788 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12789 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12790 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12791 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012792 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012793 configuration language.
12794
12795 Example:
12796 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012797 bind *:8881
12798 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012799 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012800
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012801debug
12802 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12803 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12804 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12805
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012806div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012807 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12808 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012809 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012810 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12811 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012812 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012813 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12814 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12815 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12816 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12817 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012818 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012819
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012820djb2([<avalanche>])
12821 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12822 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12823 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12824 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12825 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12826 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12827 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012828 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12829 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012830
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012831even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012832 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012833 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12834
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012835field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12836 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12837 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12838 list of chars.
12839
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012840hex
12841 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12842 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12843 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12844 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012845
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012846hex2i
12847 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12848 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12849
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012850http_date([<offset>])
12851 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12852 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12853 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12854 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12855 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12856 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012857
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012858in_table(<table>)
12859 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12860 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12861 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12862 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12863 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12864
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012865ipmask(<mask>)
12866 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12867 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12868 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12869 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12870
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012871json([<input-code>])
12872 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12873 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012874 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012875 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12876 of errors:
12877 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12878 bytes, ...)
12879 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12880 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12881
12882 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12883 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12884 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12885 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12886 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12887 are :
12888 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12889 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12890 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12891 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12892 error ;
12893 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12894 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12895
12896 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12897 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12898
12899 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012900 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012901 capture request header user-agent len 150
12902 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012903
12904 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12905 GET / HTTP/1.0
12906 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12907
12908 Output log:
12909 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12910
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012911language(<value>[,<default>])
12912 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12913 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12914 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12915 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12916 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12917 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12918 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12919 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12920 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12921 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12922 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12923 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012924
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012925 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012926
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012927 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12928 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012929
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012930 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12931 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12932 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12933 use_backend spanish if es
12934 use_backend french if fr
12935 use_backend english if en
12936 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012937
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012938lower
12939 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12940 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12941 type. The result is of type string.
12942
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012943ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12944 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12945 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12946 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12947 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12948 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12949 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12950
12951 Example :
12952
12953 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12954 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12955 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12956
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012957map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12958map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12959map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12960 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12961 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12962 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12963 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12964 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12965 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12966 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12967 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012968
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012969 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12970 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12971 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012972
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012973 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012974 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012975
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012976 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12977 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12978 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12979 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012980 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12981 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012982 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12983 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12984 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12985 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12986 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12987 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12988 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12989 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012990 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12991 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12992 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012993 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12994 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12995 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12996 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12997 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012998
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012999 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13000 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13001 the corresponding match text.
13002
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013003 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13004 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13005 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13006 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13007 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013008
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013009 Example :
13010
13011 # this is a comment and is ignored
13012 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13013 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13014 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13015 | | | `---------- value
13016 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13017 | `---------------------------- key
13018 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13019
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013020mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013021 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13022 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013023 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013024 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013025 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013026 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13027 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13028 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13029 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
13030 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013031 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013032
13033mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013034 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013035 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13036 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013037 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013038 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013039 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013040 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13041 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13042 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13043 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
13044 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013045 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013046
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013047nbsrv
13048 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13049 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13050 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13051 map lookup.
13052
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013053neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013054 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13055 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13056 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13057 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013058
13059not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013060 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013061 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
13062 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
13063 absence of a flag).
13064
13065odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013066 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013067 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13068
13069or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013070 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013071 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013072 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13073 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013074 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013075 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13076 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13077 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13078 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
13079 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013080 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013081
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013082regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013083 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13084 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13085 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13086 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13087 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13088 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13089 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13090 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13091 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13092 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013093 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13094 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13095 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13096 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013097
13098 Example :
13099
13100 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13101 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13102 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13103 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13104
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013105capture-req(<id>)
13106 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13107 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13108
13109 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013110 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13111 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013112
13113capture-res(<id>)
13114 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13115 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13116
13117 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013118 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13119 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013120
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013121sdbm([<avalanche>])
13122 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13123 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13124 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13125 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13126 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13127 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13128 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013129 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
13130 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013131
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013132set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013133 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
13134 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
13135 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013136 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013137 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13138 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013139 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013140 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13141 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013142 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013143 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013144
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013145sha1
13146 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13147 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13148
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013149sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013150 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13151 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013152 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013153 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13154 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013155 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013156 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13157 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013158 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013159 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13160 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013161 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013162 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013163
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013164table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13165 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13166 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13167 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13168 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13169 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13170 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13171
13172
13173table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13174 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13175 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13176 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13177 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13178 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13179 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13180
13181table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13182 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13183 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13184 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13185 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13186 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13187
13188table_conn_cur(<table>)
13189 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13190 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13191 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13192 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13193 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13194
13195table_conn_rate(<table>)
13196 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13197 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13198 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13199 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13200 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13201
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013202table_gpt0(<table>)
13203 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13204 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13205 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13206 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13207 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13208
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013209table_gpc0(<table>)
13210 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13211 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13212 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13213 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13214 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13215
13216table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13217 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13218 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13219 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13220 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13221 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13222 sample fetch keyword.
13223
13224table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13225 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13226 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13227 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13228 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13229 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13230
13231table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13232 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13233 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13234 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13235 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13236 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13237 keyword.
13238
13239table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13240 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13241 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13242 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13243 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13244 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13245
13246table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13247 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13248 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13249 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13250 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13251 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13252 keyword.
13253
13254table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13255 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13256 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13257 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
13258 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13259 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13260 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13261 keyword.
13262
13263table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13264 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13265 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13266 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
13267 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13268 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13269 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13270 keyword.
13271
13272table_server_id(<table>)
13273 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13274 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13275 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13276 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13277 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13278 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13279
13280table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13281 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13282 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13283 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13284 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13285 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13286 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13287 keyword.
13288
13289table_sess_rate(<table>)
13290 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13291 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13292 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13293 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13294 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13295 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13296 keyword.
13297
13298table_trackers(<table>)
13299 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13300 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13301 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13302 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13303 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13304 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13305 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13306 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13307 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13308 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13309
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013310upper
13311 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13312 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13313 type. The result is of type string.
13314
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013315url_dec
13316 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13317 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13318
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013319unset-var(<var name>)
13320 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13321 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13322 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13323 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13324 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13325 response),
13326 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13327 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13328 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13329 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13330
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013331utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13332 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13333 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13334 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13335 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13336 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13337 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13338
13339 Example :
13340
13341 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13342 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13343 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13344
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013345word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13346 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13347 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13348
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013349wt6([<avalanche>])
13350 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13351 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13352 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13353 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13354 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13355 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13356 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013357 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13358 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013359
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013360xor(<value>)
13361 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013362 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013363 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013364 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013365 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013366 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13367 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013368 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013369 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13370 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013371 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013372 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013373
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013374xxh32([<seed>])
13375 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13376 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13377 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13378 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13379 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13380 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13381 as cryptographically secure.
13382
13383xxh64([<seed>])
13384 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13385 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13386 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13387 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13388 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13389 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13390 as cryptographically secure.
13391
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013392
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133937.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013394--------------------------------------------
13395
13396A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13397not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13398"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13399The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13400
13401always_false : boolean
13402 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13403 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13404
13405always_true : boolean
13406 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13407 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13408
13409avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013410 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013411 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13412 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13413 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13414 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13415 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13416 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13417 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13418 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13419 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13420 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13421 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13422 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13423 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013425be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013426 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13427 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13428 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13429 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13430 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013432be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13433 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13434 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13435 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13436 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13437 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13438 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013439
13440 Example :
13441 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13442 backend dynamic
13443 mode http
13444 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13445 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013446
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013447bin(<hexa>) : bin
13448 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13449 of the string.
13450
13451bool(<bool>) : bool
13452 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13453 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13456 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013457 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013458 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13459 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013460
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013461 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013462 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013463 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13464
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013465 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13466 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013467
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013468 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013469 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013470 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013471 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13472 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013474 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013475
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013476 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13477 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013478 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013479 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013480
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013481date([<offset>]) : integer
13482 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13483 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13484 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13485 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013486 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13487
13488 Example :
13489
13490 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13491 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013492
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013493distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13494 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13495 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13496 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13497 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13498 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13499 list of supported tokens.
13500
13501distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13502 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13503 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13504 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13505 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13506 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13507 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13508 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13509 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13510 supported tokens.
13511
13512 Example :
13513 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13514 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13515 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13516 # send large files to the big farm
13517 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13518
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013519env(<name>) : string
13520 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13521 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13522 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13523 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13524 certain way.
13525
13526 Examples :
13527 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13528 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13529
13530 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13531 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013533fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13534 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013535 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13536 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013537 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13538 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13539 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13540 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13541 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013542
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013543fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13544 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13545 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13546 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013548fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13549 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13550 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13551 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13552 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13553 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13554 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13555 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13556 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013557
13558 Example :
13559 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13560 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13561 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13562 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13563 frontend mail
13564 bind :25
13565 mode tcp
13566 maxconn 100
13567 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13568 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13569 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13570 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013571
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013572hostname : string
13573 Returns the system hostname.
13574
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013575int(<integer>) : signed integer
13576 Returns a signed integer.
13577
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013578ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13579 Returns an ipv4.
13580
13581ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13582 Returns an ipv6.
13583
13584meth(<method>) : method
13585 Returns a method.
13586
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013587nbproc : integer
13588 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13589 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13590 and debugging purposes.
13591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013592nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13593 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13594 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13595 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013596 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13597 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13598 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013599
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013600proc : integer
13601 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13602 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13603 debugging purposes.
13604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013605queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013606 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13607 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13608 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013609 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13610 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13611 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13612 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13613 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13614
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013615rand([<range>]) : integer
13616 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13617 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13618 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13619 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13620 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013622srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13623 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13624 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13625 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13626 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13627 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13628 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13629 methods.
13630
13631srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13632 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13633 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13634 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13635 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13636 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13637 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13638 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13639
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013640srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13641 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13642 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13643 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13644 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13645 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13646 fetch methods.
13647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013648srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13649 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13650 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013651 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013652 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13653 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13654 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13655 overloading servers).
13656
13657 Example :
13658 # Redirect to a separate back
13659 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13660 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13661 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13662
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013663stopping : boolean
13664 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13665 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13666 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13667
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013668str(<string>) : string
13669 Returns a string.
13670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013671table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13672 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13673 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13674
13675table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13676 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13677 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13678 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13679
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010013680thread : integer
13681 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
13682 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
13683 and debugging purposes.
13684
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013685var(<var-name>) : undefined
13686 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013687 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13688 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013689 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013690 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13691 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013692 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013693 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13694 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013695 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013696 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013697
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136987.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013699----------------------------------
13700
13701The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13702closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13703methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13704sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13705TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013706the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13707counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13708"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013709argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13710the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13711this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013712
13713be_id : integer
13714 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13715 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13716
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013717be_name : string
13718 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13719 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013721dst : ip
13722 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13723 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13724 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13725 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13726 RFC 4291.
13727
13728dst_conn : integer
13729 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13730 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13731 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13732 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13733 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13734 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13735 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13736 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013737
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013738dst_is_local : boolean
13739 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13740 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13741 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13742 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13743 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13744 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13745 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13746 it only once per connection.
13747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013748dst_port : integer
13749 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13750 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13751 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13752 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13753 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13754 an HTTP header.
13755
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020013756fc_http_major : integer
13757 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
13758 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
13759 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
13760
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013761fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13762 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13763 header.
13764
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013765fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13766 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13767 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13768 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13769 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13770 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13771 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13772
13773fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13774 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13775 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13776 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13777 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13778 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13779 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13780
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013781fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13782 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13783 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13784 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13785 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13786
13787fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13788 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13789 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13790 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13791 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13792
13793fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13794 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13795 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13796 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13797 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13798
13799fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13800 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13801 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13802 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13803 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13804
13805fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13806 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13807 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13808 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13809 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13810
13811fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13812 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13813 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13814 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13815 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013817fe_id : integer
13818 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013819 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013820 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13821
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013822fe_name : string
13823 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13824 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13825 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13826
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013827sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013828sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13829sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13830sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013831 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13832 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13833 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13834
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013835sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013836sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13837sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13838sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013839 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13840 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13841 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13842
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013843sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013844sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13845sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13846sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013847 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13848 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013849 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13850 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13851 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013852
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013853 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013854 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13855 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013856 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13857 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13858 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013859 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13860 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13861
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013862sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013863sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13864sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13865sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013866 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13867 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13868
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013869sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013870sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13871sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13872sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013873 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13874 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13875 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13876
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013877sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013878sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13879sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13880sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013881 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13882 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13883 See also src_conn_rate.
13884
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013885sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013886sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13887sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13888sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013889 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013890 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013891
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013892sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13893sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13894sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13895sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13896 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13897 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13898
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013899sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013900sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13901sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13902sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013903 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13904 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13905 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013906 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13907 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13908 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013909
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013910sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013911sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13912sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13913sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013914 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13915 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13916 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13917
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013918sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013919sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13920sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13921sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013922 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13923 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13924 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13925 src_http_err_rate.
13926
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013927sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013928sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13929sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13930sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013931 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13932 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13933 src_http_req_cnt.
13934
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013935sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013936sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13937sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13938sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013939 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13940 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13941 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13942 src_http_req_rate.
13943
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013944sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013945sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13946sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13947sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013948 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013949 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13950 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13951 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13952 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013953
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013954 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013955 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13956 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013957 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13958
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013959sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013960sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13961sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13962sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013963 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13964 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13965 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013966
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013967sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013968sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13969sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13970sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013971 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13972 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13973 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013974
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013975sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013976sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13977sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13978sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013979 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13980 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13981 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13982 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013983 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013984 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13985
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013986sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013987sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13988sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13989sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013990 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13991 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13992 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13993 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13994 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013995 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013996
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013997sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013998sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13999sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14000sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014001 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14002 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14003 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14004
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014005sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014006sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14007sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14008sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014009 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14010 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014011 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014012 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14013 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014014 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14015 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14016 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018so_id : integer
14019 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14020 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14021 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014023src : ip
14024 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
14025 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14026 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14027 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014028 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14029 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14030 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
14031 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014032
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014033 Example:
14034 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14035 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014037src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14038 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14039 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14040 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014041 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014043src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14044 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14045 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014046 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014047 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014049src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14050 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14051 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14052 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14053 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14054 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14055 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014056
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014057 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014058 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14059 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14060 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14061 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014062 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014063 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14064 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014066src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014067 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014068 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014069 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014070 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014072src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014073 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014074 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14075 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014076 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014078src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14079 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14080 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14081 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014082 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014084src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014085 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014086 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014087 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014088 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014089
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014090src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14091 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14092 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14093 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14094 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014096src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014097 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014098 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014099 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14100 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014101 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14102 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14103 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014105src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14106 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
14107 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014108 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014109 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014110 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014112src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14113 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14114 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14115 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14116 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014117 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014119src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14120 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14121 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14122 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014123 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014125src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14126 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14127 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14128 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014129 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014130 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014132src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14133 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14134 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14135 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014136 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014137 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14138 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014139
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014140 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014141 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014142 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014143 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014144
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014145src_is_local : boolean
14146 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14147 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14148 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14149 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
14150 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
14151 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14152 once per connection.
14153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014154src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014155 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14156 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14157 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14158 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14159 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014161src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014162 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14163 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14164 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14165 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14166 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014168src_port : integer
14169 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14170 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14171 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14172 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014174src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14175 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014176 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14177 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14178 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014179 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014181src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14182 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14183 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14184 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14185 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014186 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014188src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14189 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14190 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14191 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14192 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14193 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14194 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14195 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14196 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014197
14198 Example :
14199 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14200 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14201 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14202 listen ssh
14203 bind :22
14204 mode tcp
14205 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014206 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014207 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014208 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014210srv_id : integer
14211 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14212 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14213 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014214
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142157.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014216----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014218The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14219closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14220when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14221usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014222future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014223
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001422451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14225 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14226 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14227 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14228 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14229 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14230
14231 Example :
14232 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14233 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14234 # the request.
14235 frontend http-in
14236 bind *:8081
14237 default_backend servers
14238 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14239 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14240
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014241ssl_bc : boolean
14242 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14243 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14244 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14245
14246ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14247 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14248 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14249
14250ssl_bc_cipher : string
14251 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14252 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14253
14254ssl_bc_protocol : string
14255 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14256 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14257
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014258ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014259 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014260 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14261 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014262
14263ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14264 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14265 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14266 if session was reused or not.
14267
14268ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14269 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14270 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14273 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14274 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14275 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14276 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14277 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014279ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14280 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14281 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14282 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14283 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014284
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014285ssl_c_der : binary
14286 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14287 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14288 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014290ssl_c_err : integer
14291 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14292 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14293 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14294 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14295 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014297ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14298 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14299 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14300 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14301 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14302 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14303 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14304 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14305 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014307ssl_c_key_alg : string
14308 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14309 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14310 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014312ssl_c_notafter : string
14313 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14314 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14315 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014317ssl_c_notbefore : string
14318 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14319 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14320 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014322ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14323 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14324 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14325 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14326 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14327 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14328 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14329 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14330 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014332ssl_c_serial : binary
14333 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14334 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14335 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014337ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14338 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14339 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14340 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014341 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14342 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14343
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014344 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014345 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014347ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14348 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14349 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14350 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014352ssl_c_used : boolean
14353 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14354 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014356ssl_c_verify : integer
14357 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14358 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14359 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14360 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014362ssl_c_version : integer
14363 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14364 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014365
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014366ssl_f_der : binary
14367 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14368 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14369 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14372 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14373 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14374 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14375 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014376 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14378 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14379 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014381ssl_f_key_alg : string
14382 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14383 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14384 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014386ssl_f_notafter : string
14387 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14388 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14389 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014391ssl_f_notbefore : string
14392 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14393 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14394 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014396ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14397 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14398 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14399 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14400 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14401 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14402 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14403 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14404 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014406ssl_f_serial : binary
14407 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14408 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14409 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014410
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014411ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14412 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14413 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14414 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014416ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14417 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14418 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14419 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014421ssl_f_version : integer
14422 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14423 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14424
14425ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014426 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14427 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14428 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014430 Example :
14431 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14432 listen http-https
14433 bind :80
14434 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14435 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14436
14437ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14438 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14439 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14440
14441ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014442 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014443 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14444 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14445 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14446 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14447 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14448 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14449 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14450 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014452ssl_fc_cipher : string
14453 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14454 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014455
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014456ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14457 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14458 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014459 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014460
14461ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14462 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14463 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014464 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014465
14466ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14467 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14468 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14469 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014470 avaible with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
14471 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014472
14473ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14474 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14475 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014476 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014478ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014479 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14480 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014481 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14482 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14483 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14484 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014485
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014486ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14487 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14488 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14489 wait until the handshake happened.
14490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014491ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14492 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014493 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14494 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14495 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14496 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014497
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014498ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014499 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14500 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014502ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014503 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014504 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14505 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14506 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14507 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14508 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14509 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14510 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014512ssl_fc_protocol : string
14513 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14514 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014515
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014516ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014517 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014518 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14519 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014521ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14522 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14523 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14524 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14525 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014527ssl_fc_sni : string
14528 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14529 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14530 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14531 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14532 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14533
14534 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14535 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14536 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014537 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14538 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014540 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014541 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14542 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014544ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14545 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14546 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014547
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014548
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200145497.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014550------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014552Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14553sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14554only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14555For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14556be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14557can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14558sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14559for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14560content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14563 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14564 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14565 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14568 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14569 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14570 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014571
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014572req.hdrs : string
14573 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14574 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14575 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14576 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14577
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014578req.hdrs_bin : binary
14579 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14580 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14581 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14582 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14583 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14584 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14585
14586 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14587
14588 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14589 str: <int:length><bytes>
14590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014591req.len : integer
14592req_len : integer (deprecated)
14593 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14594 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14595 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14596 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14597 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14598 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14599 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14600 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014602req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14603 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014604 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14605 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14606 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14607 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014609 ACL alternatives :
14610 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014612req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14613 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14614 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14615 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14616 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014618 ACL alternatives :
14619 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014621 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014623req.proto_http : boolean
14624req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14625 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14626 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14627 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14628 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14629 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14630 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14631 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014633 Example:
14634 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14635 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14636 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014637 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014639req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14640rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14641 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14642 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14643 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14644 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14645 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14646 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14647 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014649 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14650 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14651 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14652 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14653 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14654 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014656 ACL derivatives :
14657 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014659 Example :
14660 listen tse-farm
14661 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14662 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14663 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14664 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14665 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14666 persist rdp-cookie
14667 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14668 # This is only useful makes sense if
14669 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14670 stick-table type string size 204800
14671 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14672 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14673 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014675 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14676 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014678req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14679rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14680 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14681 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14682 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14683 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014685 ACL derivatives :
14686 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014687
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014688req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14689 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14690 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014691 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14692 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14693 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14694 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14695 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014697req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14698req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14699 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14700 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14701 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14702 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14703 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14704 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14705 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014707req.ssl_sni : string
14708req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14709 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14710 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14711 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14712 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14713 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14714 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14715 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14716 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14717 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14718 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14719 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14720 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014722 ACL derivatives :
14723 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014725 Examples :
14726 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14727 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14728 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14729 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14730 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014731
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014732req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14733 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14734 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14735 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14736 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14737 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14738 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14739 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14740 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14741 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014743req.ssl_ver : integer
14744req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14745 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14746 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14747 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14748 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14749 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14750 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14751 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14752 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14753 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014755 ACL derivatives :
14756 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014757
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014758res.len : integer
14759 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14760 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14761 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14762 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14763 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14764 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14765 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14766 content inspection.
14767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14769 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014770 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14771 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14772 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14773 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014775res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14776 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14777 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14778 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14779 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014781 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014782
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014783res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14784rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14785 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14786 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14787 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14788 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14789 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14790 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14791 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014793wait_end : boolean
14794 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14795 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14796 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14797 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14798 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14799 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14800 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14801 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014803 Examples :
14804 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14805 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14806 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014808 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14809 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14810 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14811 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14812 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14813 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14814 tcp-request content reject
14815
14816
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200148177.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014818--------------------------------------
14819
14820It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14821This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14822data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14823its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14824HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14825content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14826to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14827more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14828response are indexed.
14829
14830base : string
14831 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14832 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14833 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14834 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14835 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14836 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14837 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14838 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14839
14840 ACL derivatives :
14841 base : exact string match
14842 base_beg : prefix match
14843 base_dir : subdir match
14844 base_dom : domain match
14845 base_end : suffix match
14846 base_len : length match
14847 base_reg : regex match
14848 base_sub : substring match
14849
14850base32 : integer
14851 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14852 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14853 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014854 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14855 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14856 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014857
14858base32+src : binary
14859 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14860 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14861 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14862 per-URL counters.
14863
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014864capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14865 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14866 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14867 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14868
14869capture.req.method : string
14870 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14871 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14872 because it's allocated.
14873
14874capture.req.uri : string
14875 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14876 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14877 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14878 allocated.
14879
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014880capture.req.ver : string
14881 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14882 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14883 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14884
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014885capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14886 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14887 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14888 The first entry is an index of 0.
14889 See also: "capture response header"
14890
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014891capture.res.ver : string
14892 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14893 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14894 persistent flag.
14895
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014896req.body : binary
14897 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14898 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14899 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14900 the first chunk is analyzed.
14901
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014902req.body_param([<name>) : string
14903 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14904 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14905 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14906 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14907 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14908 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14909 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14910 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14911 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14912 given.
14913
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014914req.body_len : integer
14915 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14916 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14917 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14918 "option http-buffer-request".
14919
14920req.body_size : integer
14921 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14922 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14923 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14924 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14925 "option http-buffer-request".
14926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927req.cook([<name>]) : string
14928cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14929 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14930 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14931 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14932 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14933 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14934 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14935 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14936 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14937
14938 ACL derivatives :
14939 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14940 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14941 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14942 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14943 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14944 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14945 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14946 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014948req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14949cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14950 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14951 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014953req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14954cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14955 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14956 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14957 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14958 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014960cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14961 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14962 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14963 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14964 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014965 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014966 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14967 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14968 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14969 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014971hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14972 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14973 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14974 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14975 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014976 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014978req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14979 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14980 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14981 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14982 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14983 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14984 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14985 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14986 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014988req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14989 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14990 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14991 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14992 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014994req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14995 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14996 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14997 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14998 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14999 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15000 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15001 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15002 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015003 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015004 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
15005 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015007 ACL derivatives :
15008 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15009 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15010 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15011 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15012 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15013 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15014 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15015 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15016
15017req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15018hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15019 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15020 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15021 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15022 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15023 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15024 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15025 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15026 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15027 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15028
15029req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15030hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15031 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15032 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15033 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15034 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15035 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15036 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15037 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15038 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15039
15040req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15041hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15042 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15043 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15044 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15045 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15046 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15047 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15048 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15049
15050http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15051 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15052 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15053 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15054 basic auth is supported.
15055
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015056http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15057 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15058 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15059 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15060 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015061 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15062 basic auth is supported.
15063
15064 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015065 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15066 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15067 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15068 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015069
15070http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015071 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15072 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015073 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15074 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076method : integer + string
15077 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15078 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15079 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15080 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15081 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15082 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15083 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015085 ACL derivatives :
15086 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088 Example :
15089 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15090 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15091 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015093path : string
15094 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15095 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15096 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15097 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15098 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
15099 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
15100 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015102 ACL derivatives :
15103 path : exact string match
15104 path_beg : prefix match
15105 path_dir : subdir match
15106 path_dom : domain match
15107 path_end : suffix match
15108 path_len : length match
15109 path_reg : regex match
15110 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015111
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015112query : string
15113 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15114 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15115 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15116 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015117 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015118 which stops before the question mark.
15119
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015120req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15121 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15122 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15123 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15124 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015126req.ver : string
15127req_ver : string (deprecated)
15128 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15129 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15130 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132 ACL derivatives :
15133 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015135res.comp : boolean
15136 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15137 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15138 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015140res.comp_algo : string
15141 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15142 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15143 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015145res.cook([<name>]) : string
15146scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15147 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15148 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15149 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015151 ACL derivatives :
15152 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015154res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15155scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15156 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15157 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15158 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015160res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15161scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15162 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15163 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15164 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015166res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15167 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15168 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15169 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15170 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15171 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15172 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15173 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15174 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15175 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015177res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15178 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15179 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15180 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15181 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15182 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015184res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15185shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15186 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15187 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15188 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15189 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15190 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15191 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15192 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15193 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015195 ACL derivatives :
15196 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15197 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15198 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15199 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15200 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15201 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15202 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15203 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15204
15205res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15206shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15207 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15208 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15209 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15210 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15211 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15214shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15215 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15216 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15217 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15218 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15219 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15220 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015221
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015222res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15223 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15224 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15225 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15226 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015228res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15229shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15230 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15231 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15232 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15233 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15234 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15235 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015237res.ver : string
15238resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15239 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15240 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015242 ACL derivatives :
15243 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015245set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15246 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15247 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015248 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015249 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15252 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015254status : integer
15255 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15256 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15257 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015258
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015259unique-id : string
15260 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15261 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15262 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15263 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15264 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15265 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015267url : string
15268 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15269 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15270 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15271 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15272 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15273 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15274 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015276 ACL derivatives :
15277 url : exact string match
15278 url_beg : prefix match
15279 url_dir : subdir match
15280 url_dom : domain match
15281 url_end : suffix match
15282 url_len : length match
15283 url_reg : regex match
15284 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015286url_ip : ip
15287 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15288 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15289 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15290 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15291 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15292 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15293 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015295url_port : integer
15296 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15297 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15298 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15299 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015300
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015301urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15302url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015303 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15304 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015305 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15306 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15307 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15308 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15310 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015311 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15312 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015314 ACL derivatives :
15315 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15316 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15317 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15318 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15319 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15320 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15321 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15322 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015323
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015325 Example :
15326 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15327 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15328 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15329 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015330
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015331urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015332 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15333 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15334 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015335
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015336url32 : integer
15337 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15338 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15339 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15340 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15341 is an unsigned integer.
15342
15343url32+src : binary
15344 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15345 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15346 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15347
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153497.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015350---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015352Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15353every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015354order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015356ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15357---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015358FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015359HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015360HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15361HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015362HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15363HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15364HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15365HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15366LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015367METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015368METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015369METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15370METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15371METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15372METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015373METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015374METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015375RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015376REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015377TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015378WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15379---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015380
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153828. Logging
15383----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015384
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015385One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15386provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15387very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15388provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15389state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015390to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015391headers.
15392
15393In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15394about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15395send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15396
15397 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15398 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15399 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15400 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15401 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015402 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15403 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015404
15405The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15406allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15407as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15408while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15409real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15410delay.
15411
15412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154138.1. Log levels
15414---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015415
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015416TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015417source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015418HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15419in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15420track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15421syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15422about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015423
15424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154258.2. Log formats
15426----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015427
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015428HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015429and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15430slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15431options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015432
15433 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15434 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15435 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15436 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15437 extents.
15438
15439 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15440 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15441 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15442 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15443 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15444
15445 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15446 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15447 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15448 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15449 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15450
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015451 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15452 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15453 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15454 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15455
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015456 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15457
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015458Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15459specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15460field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15461servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15462always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15463identifier.
15464
15465Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15466 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15467 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15468 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15469 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15470
15471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154728.2.1. Default log format
15473-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015474
15475This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15476as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15477format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15478
15479 Example :
15480 listen www
15481 mode http
15482 log global
15483 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15484
15485 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15486 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15487 (www/HTTP)
15488
15489 Field Format Extract from the example above
15490 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15491 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15492 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15493 4 'to' to
15494 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15495 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15496
15497Detailed fields description :
15498 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15499 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15500 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15501 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15502 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15503 and processed the connection.
15504 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15505
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015506In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15507"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15508connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15509
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015510It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15511will eventually disappear.
15512
15513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155148.2.2. TCP log format
15515---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015516
15517The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15518is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15519information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15520counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15521emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15522environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15523the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15524sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015525specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15526not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15527fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15528marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015529
15530 Example :
15531 frontend fnt
15532 mode tcp
15533 option tcplog
15534 log global
15535 default_backend bck
15536
15537 backend bck
15538 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15539
15540 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15541 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15542 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15543
15544 Field Format Extract from the example above
15545 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15546 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15547 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15548 4 frontend_name fnt
15549 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15550 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15551 7 bytes_read* 212
15552 8 termination_state --
15553 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15554 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15555
15556Detailed fields description :
15557 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015558 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15559 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15560 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015561 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15562 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15563 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015564
15565 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015566 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15567 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15568 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015569
15570 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15571 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15572 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15573 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15574
15575 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15576 and processed the connection.
15577
15578 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15579 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15580 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15581 applications.
15582
15583 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15584 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15585 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15586 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15587 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15588
15589 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15590 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15591 See "Timers" below for more details.
15592
15593 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15594 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15595 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15596 "Timers" below for more details.
15597
15598 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015599 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015600 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15601 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15602 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15603 details.
15604
15605 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15606 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15607 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15608 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15609 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15610
15611 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15612 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15613 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15614 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15615 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15616 for more details.
15617
15618 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015619 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015620 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15621 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15622 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015623 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015624
15625 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15626 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15627 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15628 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15629 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15630 caused by a denial of service attack.
15631
15632 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15633 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15634 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15635 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15636 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15637 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15638 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15639 denial of service attack.
15640
15641 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15642 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15643 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15644 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15645 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15646 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15647 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15648 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15649 be processed than on other servers.
15650
15651 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15652 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15653 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15654 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15655 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15656 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15657 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15658 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15659 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15660 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15661 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15662 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15663 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15664
15665 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15666 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15667 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15668 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15669 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15670 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15671 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15672 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15673
15674 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15675 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15676 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15677 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15678 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15679 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15680 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15681 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15682 occurs.
15683
15684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156858.2.3. HTTP log format
15686----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015687
15688The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15689is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15690the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15691are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15692emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15693generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15694"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15695which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015696frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15697is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015698
15699Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15700slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15701with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15702
15703 Example :
15704 frontend http-in
15705 mode http
15706 option httplog
15707 log global
15708 default_backend bck
15709
15710 backend static
15711 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15712
15713 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15714 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15715 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015716 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015717
15718 Field Format Extract from the example above
15719 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15720 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015721 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015722 4 frontend_name http-in
15723 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015724 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015725 7 status_code 200
15726 8 bytes_read* 2750
15727 9 captured_request_cookie -
15728 10 captured_response_cookie -
15729 11 termination_state ----
15730 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15731 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15732 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15733 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15734 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015735
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015736Detailed fields description :
15737 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015738 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15739 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15740 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015741 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15742 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15743 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015744
15745 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015746 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15747 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15748 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015749
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015750 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15751 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015752
15753 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15754 and processed the connection.
15755
15756 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15757 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15758 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15759
15760 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15761 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15762 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15763 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15764 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15765 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15766
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015767 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15768 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15769 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15770 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15771 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15772 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15773 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015774
15775 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15776 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15777 See "Timers" below for more details.
15778
15779 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15780 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15781 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15782 below for more details.
15783
15784 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15785 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15786 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15787 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15788 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15789 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15790 for more details.
15791
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015792 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15793 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15794 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15795 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15796 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15797 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15798 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15799 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015800
15801 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15802 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15803 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15804
15805 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15806 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15807 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15808 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15809 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15810 overflowing.
15811
15812 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15813 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15814 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15815 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15816 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15817 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15818 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15819 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15820
15821 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15822 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15823 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15824 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15825 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15826 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15827 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15828 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15829
15830 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15831 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15832 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15833 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15834 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15835 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15836 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15837
15838 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015839 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015840 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15841 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15842 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015843 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015844 system.
15845
15846 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15847 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15848 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15849 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15850 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15851 caused by a denial of service attack.
15852
15853 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15854 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15855 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15856 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15857 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15858 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15859 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15860 denial of service attack.
15861
15862 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15863 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15864 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15865 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15866 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15867 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15868 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15869 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15870 processed than on other servers.
15871
15872 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15873 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15874 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15875 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15876 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15877 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15878 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15879 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15880 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15881 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15882 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15883 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15884 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15885
15886 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15887 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15888 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15889 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15890 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15891 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15892 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15893 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15894
15895 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15896 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15897 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15898 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15899 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15900 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15901 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15902 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15903 occurs.
15904
15905 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15906 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15907 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15908 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15909 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15910 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15911 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15912 cookies" below for more details.
15913
15914 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15915 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15916 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15917 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15918 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15919 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15920 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15921 and cookies" below for more details.
15922
15923 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15924 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15925 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15926 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15927 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15928 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15929 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15930 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15931
15932
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200159338.2.4. Custom log format
15934------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015935
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015936The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015937mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015938
15939HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15940Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15941separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15942prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15943
15944Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15945variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015946("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015947
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015948If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015949as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015950less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15951the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15952
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015953Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015954In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015955in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015956
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015957Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15958'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15959https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15960such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15961
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015962Flags are :
15963 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015964 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015965 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15966 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015967
15968 Example:
15969
15970 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15971 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15972
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015973 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15974
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015975At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15976
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015977 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15978 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015979
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015980the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015981
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015982 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15983 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15984 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015985
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015986and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15987
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015988 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15989 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015990
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015991Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15992
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015993 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015994 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015995 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15996 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15997 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015998 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15999 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16000 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016001 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016002 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16003 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016004 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016005 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16006 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016007 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016008 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016009 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016010 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016011 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016012 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016013 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016014 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16015 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16016 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16017 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16018 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016019 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016020 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16021 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016022 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016023 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16024 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016025 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16026 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16027 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016028 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016029 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16030 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016031 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016032 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16033 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16034 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016035 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016036 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016037 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16038 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16039 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16040 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016041 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016042 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016043 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016044 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016045 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016046 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016047 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16048 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16049 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016050 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016051 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16052 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016053 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016054 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16055 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
16056 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016057 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016058 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016059 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016060
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016061 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016062
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016063
160648.2.5. Error log format
16065-----------------------
16066
16067When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16068protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16069By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16070"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
16071will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
16072logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16073
16074The format looks like this :
16075
16076 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16077 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16078 Connection error during SSL handshake
16079
16080 Field Format Extract from the example above
16081 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16082 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16083 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16084 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16085 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16086
16087These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16088failures.
16089
16090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160918.3. Advanced logging options
16092-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016093
16094Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16095just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16096options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16097for more information about their usage.
16098
16099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161008.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16101------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016102
16103It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16104haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16105commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16106monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16107ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16108
16109 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16110 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16111 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16112 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16113
16114 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16115 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16116 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016117 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016118 such as other load-balancers.
16119
16120 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16121 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16122 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16123
16124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161258.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16126----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016127
16128The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16129what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16130or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
16131"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
16132just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16133log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16134after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16135is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16136with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16137with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16138
16139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161408.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16141------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016142
16143Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16144for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16145"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16146retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16147raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16148a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16149file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16150you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16151"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16152
16153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161548.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16155--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016156
16157Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16158multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16159them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16160"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16161logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16162error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16163and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16164too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16165useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16166alternative.
16167
16168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161698.4. Timing events
16170------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016171
16172Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16173reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16174the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16175frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016176mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16177addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16178
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016179Timings events in HTTP mode:
16180
16181 first request 2nd request
16182 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16183 t tr t tr ...
16184 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16185 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16186 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16187 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16188 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16189
16190Timings events in TCP mode:
16191
16192 TCP session
16193 |<----------------->|
16194 t t
16195 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16196 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16197 |<------ Tt ------->|
16198
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016199 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
16200 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
16201 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16202 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16203 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
16204 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
16205 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016206
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016207 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16208 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16209 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
16210 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
16211 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
16212 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
16213 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
16214 nothing was received on the connection.
16215
16216 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16217 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16218 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16219 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16220 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16221 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16222 request typed by hand during a test.
16223
16224 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16225 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
16226 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
16227 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16228 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16229 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16230 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016231
16232 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16233 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16234 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16235 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16236 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16237
16238 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16239 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16240 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16241 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16242 connection never established.
16243
16244 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16245 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16246 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16247 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16248 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16249 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16250 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16251 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16252 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16253 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16254 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16255
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016256 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16257 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16258 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16259 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16260 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16261 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16262
16263 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16264
16265 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16266 "Ta" can never be negative.
16267
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016268 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16269 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016270 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16271 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016272 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016273
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016274 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016275
16276 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016277 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16278 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016279
16280These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16281protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16282that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016283due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16284"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16285that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016286
16287Most common cases :
16288
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016289 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16290 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16291 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16292 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16293 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16294 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16295 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16296 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16297 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16298 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16299 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016300 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016301
16302 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16303 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16304 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16305 of ms on remote networks.
16306
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016307 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16308 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16309 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016310
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016311 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16312 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16313 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16314 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16315 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16316 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16317 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16318 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16319 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016320
16321Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16322
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016323 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016324 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016325 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016326
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016327 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016328 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16329 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16330
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016331 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016332 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16333 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16334 flags.
16335
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016336 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16337 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016338 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16339 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16340 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16341 the client connection was maintained open.
16342
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016343 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016344 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016345 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016346 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16347
16348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163498.5. Session state at disconnection
16350-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016351
16352TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16353"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
163542-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16355each of which has a special meaning :
16356
16357 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16358 session to terminate :
16359
16360 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16361
16362 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16363 server explicitly refused it.
16364
16365 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16366 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16367 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16368 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016369 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16370
16371 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16372 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016373
16374 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16375 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16376 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16377 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16378 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16379
16380 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16381 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16382 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16383 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16384 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16385
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016386 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16387 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16388
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016389 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16390 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16391 backup connections when going up.
16392
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016393 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16394
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016395 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16396 send or receive data.
16397
16398 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16399 send or receive data.
16400
16401 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16402 with nothing left in the buffers.
16403
16404 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16405
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016406 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016407 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16408
16409 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16410 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16411 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16412 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16413 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16414
16415 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16416 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16417
16418 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16419 server (HTTP only).
16420
16421 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16422
16423 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16424 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16425 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16426
16427 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16428 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16429 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16430
16431 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16432
16433 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16434 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16435
16436 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16437 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16438 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16439
16440 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16441 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016442 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16443 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016444
16445 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16446 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16447 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16448 another server.
16449
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016450 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016451 server.
16452
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016453 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16454 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16455 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16456 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16457
16458 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16459 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16460 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16461 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16462
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016463 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16464 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16465 "use-server" rule).
16466
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016467 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16468
16469 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16470 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16471
16472 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16473
16474 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16475 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16476 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16477
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016478 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16479 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016480 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016481 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16482 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16483
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016484 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16485
16486 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16487 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16488
16489 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16490
16491 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16492
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016493The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16494was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016495helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16496starvation, attacks, etc...
16497
16498The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16499alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16500easier finding and understanding.
16501
16502 Flags Reason
16503
16504 -- Normal termination.
16505
16506 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16507 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16508 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16509 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16510
16511 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16512 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16513 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16514 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16515 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16516 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016517
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016518 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16519 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016520 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016521
16522 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16523 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16524 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16525
16526 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16527 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16528 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16529 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16530 the server takes too long to respond.
16531
16532 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16533 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16534 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16535 long a time to respond.
16536
16537 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16538 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16539 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16540 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016541 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16542 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016543
16544 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16545 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16546 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16547 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16548 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016549 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016550 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16551 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16552 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16553 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16554 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16555 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16556 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16557 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16558 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16559 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16560 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16561 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016562
16563 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16564 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016565 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16566 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16567 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16568 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016569
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016570 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16571 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16572
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016573 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016574 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16575 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16576 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16577 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16578 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16579
16580 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16581 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16582 503 or 504 here.
16583
16584 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16585 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16586 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16587 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16588 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16589
16590 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16591 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016592 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016593 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16594 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16595
16596 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16597 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16598 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16599 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16600 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16601 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16602 between haproxy and the server.
16603
16604 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16605 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16606 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16607 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16608 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16609 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16610 solution is to fix the application.
16611
16612 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16613 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16614 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16615 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16616 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16617 external attacks.
16618
16619 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16620 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016621 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016622 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16623 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16624
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016625 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16626 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16627 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016628 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16629 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016630
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016631 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16632 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16633 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16634 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016635 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16636 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16637 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16638 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16639 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016640
16641 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16642 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16643 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16644 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16645
16646 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16647 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16648 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16649 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16650
16651 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16652 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16653 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16654 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16655
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016656The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16657persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16658important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16659re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16660
16661 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16662
16663 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16664 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16665 set on a GET request.
16666
16667 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16668 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016669 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016670 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16671
16672 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16673 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16674 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16675
16676 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16677 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16678 already got a cookie.
16679
16680 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16681 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16682 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16683 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16684 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16685
16686 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16687 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16688 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16689
16690 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16691 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16692 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16693
16694 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16695 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16696
16697 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16698 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16699 then advertised in the response.
16700
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167028.6. Non-printable characters
16703-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016704
16705In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16706consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16707converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16708prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16709being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16710escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16711is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16712'}' when logging headers.
16713
16714Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16715issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16716containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16717
16718Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16719the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16720performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16721
16722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167238.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16724---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016725
16726Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16727achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016728section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016729cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16730the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16731the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016732locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016733not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16734user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16735a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16736wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16737
16738 Examples :
16739 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16740 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16741
16742 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16743 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16744
16745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167468.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16747---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016748
16749Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16750proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16751the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16752server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16753
16754Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16755response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016756section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016757
16758It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016759time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16760appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016761are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16762and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16763follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16764request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16765in the logs.
16766
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016767As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16768frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16769an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16770
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016771 Example :
16772 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16773 listen proxy-out
16774 mode http
16775 option httplog
16776 option logasap
16777 log global
16778 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16779
16780 # log the name of the virtual server
16781 capture request header Host len 20
16782
16783 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16784 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16785
16786 # log the beginning of the referrer
16787 capture request header Referer len 20
16788
16789 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16790 capture response header Server len 20
16791
16792 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16793 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16794
16795 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16796 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16797
16798 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16799 capture response header Via len 20
16800
16801 # log the URL location during a redirection
16802 capture response header Location len 20
16803
16804 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16805 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16806 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16807 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16808 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16809
16810 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16811 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16812 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16813 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016814 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016815
16816 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16817 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16818 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16819 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16820 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016821 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016822
16823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168248.9. Examples of logs
16825---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016826
16827These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16828them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16829reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16830
16831 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16832 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16833 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16834
16835 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16836 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16837
16838 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16839 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16840 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16841
16842 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16843 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16844
16845 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16846 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16847 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16848
16849 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016850 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016851 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16852 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16853
16854 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16855 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16856 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16857
16858 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16859 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016860 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016861 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16862 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16863 to return the 502 and not the server.
16864
16865 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016866 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016867
16868 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16869 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16870 Nothing was sent to any server.
16871
16872 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16873 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16874
16875 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16876 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16877 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16878 send a 408 return code to the client.
16879
16880 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16881 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16882
16883 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16884 5 seconds ("c----").
16885
16886 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16887 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016888 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016889
16890 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016891 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016892 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16893 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16894 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16895 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16896 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016897
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016898
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200168999. Supported filters
16900--------------------
16901
16902Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16903accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16904unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16905
16906See also : "filter"
16907
169089.1. Trace
16909----------
16910
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016911filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016912
16913 Arguments:
16914 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16915 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16916
16917 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16918 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16919 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16920 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16921
16922 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16923 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16924 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16925 amount of the parsed data.
16926
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016927 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16928
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016929This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16930callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16931information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16932filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16933
16934Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16935tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16936a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16937
16938
169399.2. HTTP compression
16940---------------------
16941
16942filter compression
16943
16944The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16945keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16946when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16947use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16948used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16949filters evaluation order.
16950
16951See also : "compression"
16952
16953
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200169549.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16955--------------------------------------------
16956
16957filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16958
16959 Arguments :
16960
16961 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16962 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16963 parsed.
16964
16965 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16966 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16967 part must be placed in its own scope.
16968
16969The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16970external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16971streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16972exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16973also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16974
16975SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16976the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16977
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016978For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016979"doc/SPOE.txt".
16980
16981Important note:
16982 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16983 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16984
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001698510. Cache
16986---------
16987
16988HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
16989(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
16990RAM.
16991
16992The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
16993this memory is splitted in blocks of 1k.
16994
16995If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
16996independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
16997when we try to allocate a new one.
16998
16999The cache use a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
17000
17001It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17002"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17003for more details.
17004
17005When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17006replaced by "<CACHE>".
17007
1700810.1 Limitation
17009---------------
17010
17011The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17012
17013- If the response is not a 200
17014- If the response contains a Vary header
17015- If the response does not contain a Content-Length header or if the
17016 Content-Length + the headers size is greater than a buffer size - the
17017 reserve.
17018- If the response is not cacheable
17019
17020- If the request is not a GET
17021- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
17022
17023Caution!: Due to the current limitation of the filters, it is not recommended
17024to use the cache with other filters. Using them can cause undefined behavior
17025if they modify the response (compression for exemple).
17026
1702710.2 Setup
17028----------
17029
17030To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17031the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17032
1703310.2.1 Cache section
17034--------------------
17035
17036cache <name>
17037 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17038 size of cache is mandatory.
17039
17040total-max-size <megabytes>
17041 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. this size is splitted in
17042 blocks of 1kb which are used by the cache entries.
17043
17044max-age <seconds>
17045 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17046 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17047 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17048 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17049 default.
17050
1705110.2.2 Proxy section
17052--------------------
17053
17054http-request cache-use <name>
17055 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17056 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17057 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17058 after this one.
17059
17060http-response cache-store <name>
17061 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17062 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17063 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17064 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17065
17066
17067Example:
17068
17069 backend bck1
17070 mode http
17071
17072 http-request cache-use foobar
17073 http-response cache-store foobar
17074 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17075
17076 cache foobar
17077 total-max-size 4
17078 max-age 240
17079
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017080/*
17081 * Local variables:
17082 * fill-column: 79
17083 * End:
17084 */